1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.90"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
452 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
453 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
454 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
455 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
456 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
460 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
461 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
462 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
463 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
464 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
467 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
468 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
469 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
473 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
474 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
475 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
478 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
480 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
481 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
484 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
485 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
486 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
487 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
488 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
491 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
493 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
511 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
513 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
514 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
515 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
517 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
518 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
519 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
520 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
523 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
525 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
526 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
527 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
529 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
530 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
531 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
532 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
533 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
534 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
535 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
536 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
537 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
538 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
539 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
541 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
542 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
543 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
544 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
546 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
547 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
548 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
550 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
552 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
555 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
556 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
557 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
559 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
560 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
561 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
562 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
564 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
565 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
566 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
570 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
573 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
575 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
576 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
577 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
578 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
579 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
580 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
581 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
583 .cindex "domainless addresses"
584 .cindex "address" "without domain"
585 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
586 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
587 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
588 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
591 .cindex "transport" "external"
592 .cindex "external transports"
593 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
594 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
595 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
596 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
597 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
598 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
600 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
601 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
602 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
605 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
606 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
607 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
608 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
609 a number of common scanners are provided.
613 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
614 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
615 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
616 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
617 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
618 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
621 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
622 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
623 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
624 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
625 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
626 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
627 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
628 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
629 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
630 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
631 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
632 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
634 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
635 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
636 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
637 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
641 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
642 .cindex "terminology definitions"
643 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
644 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
645 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
646 below) by a blank line.
648 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
649 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
650 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
651 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
652 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
653 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
654 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
655 rise to further bounce messages.
657 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
658 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
659 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
662 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
663 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
664 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
667 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
668 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
669 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
671 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
672 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
673 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
674 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
675 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
676 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
677 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
678 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
680 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
681 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
682 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
683 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
684 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
685 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
688 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
689 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
690 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
691 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
692 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
694 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
695 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
696 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
697 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
698 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
699 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
701 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
702 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
705 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
706 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
707 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
708 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
709 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
711 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
712 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
713 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
714 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
715 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
717 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
718 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
719 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
720 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
721 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
722 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
732 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
733 .cindex "incorporated code"
734 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
737 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
740 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
741 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
742 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
743 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
744 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
745 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
747 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
748 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
749 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
750 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
751 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
752 following statements:
755 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
757 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
758 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
759 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
761 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
762 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
763 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
764 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
765 restrictions applied to it).
768 .cindex "SPA authentication"
769 .cindex "Samba project"
770 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
771 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
772 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
773 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
777 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
778 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
779 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
780 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
781 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
782 conditions expressed therein.
785 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
787 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
788 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
792 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
793 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
795 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
796 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
797 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
800 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
801 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
802 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
803 details, please contact
805 Office of Technology Transfer
806 Carnegie Mellon University
808 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
809 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
810 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
813 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
816 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
817 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
819 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
820 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
821 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
822 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
823 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
824 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
825 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
830 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
833 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
834 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
835 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
836 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
839 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
840 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
844 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
845 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
846 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
847 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
848 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
849 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
850 software without specific, written prior permission.
852 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
853 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
854 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
855 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
856 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
857 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
862 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
863 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
864 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
865 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
866 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
870 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
871 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
872 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
882 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
883 "Receiving and delivering mail"
886 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
887 .cindex "design philosophy"
888 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
889 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
890 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
891 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
892 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
893 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
896 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
897 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
898 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
899 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
900 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
901 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
902 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
905 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
906 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
907 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
908 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
909 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
910 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
911 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
912 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
913 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
916 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
917 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
919 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
920 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
921 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
922 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
924 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
925 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
926 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
927 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
928 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
930 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
931 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
932 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
934 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
935 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
936 runs at the start of every delivery process.
941 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
942 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
943 .cindex "Sieve filter"
944 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
945 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
946 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
947 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
948 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
949 of filtering are available:
952 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
955 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
956 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
959 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
963 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
964 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
965 .cindex "format" "of message id"
966 .cindex "id of message"
971 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
972 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
973 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
974 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
975 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
976 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
977 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
978 not always case-sensitive.
980 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
981 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
982 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
983 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
984 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
985 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
989 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
990 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
991 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
992 way of representing the date and time of day).
994 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
995 received the message.
997 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
999 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1000 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1001 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1002 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1003 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1005 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1006 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1007 (1/100) of a second.
1011 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1012 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1013 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1014 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1015 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1018 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1019 .cindex "receiving mail"
1020 .cindex "message" "reception"
1021 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1022 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1023 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1024 there are several possibilities:
1027 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1028 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1029 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1031 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1032 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1033 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1034 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1035 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1036 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1039 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1040 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1041 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1042 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1044 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1045 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1046 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1047 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1051 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1052 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1053 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1054 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1055 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1056 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1057 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1058 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1059 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1060 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1061 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1062 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1063 users to change sender addresses.
1065 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1066 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1067 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1068 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1069 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1070 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1071 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1073 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1074 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1075 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1076 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1077 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1078 message is received.
1084 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1085 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1086 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1087 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1088 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1089 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1090 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1091 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1093 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1094 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1095 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1096 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1097 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1098 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1099 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1100 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1101 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1102 affect file system performance.
1104 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1105 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1106 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1107 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1108 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1110 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1111 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1112 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1113 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1114 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1115 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1116 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1117 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1118 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1119 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1120 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1121 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1125 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1126 .cindex "message" "life of"
1127 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1128 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1129 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1130 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1131 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1132 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1133 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1135 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1136 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1137 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1138 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1139 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1142 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1143 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1144 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1145 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1146 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1148 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1149 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1150 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1151 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1152 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1153 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1154 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1155 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1156 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1157 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1160 .cindex "journal file"
1161 .cindex "file" "journal"
1162 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1163 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1164 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1165 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1166 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1167 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1168 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1169 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1171 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1172 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1173 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1174 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1175 deliveries caused by crashes.
1179 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1180 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1181 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1182 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1183 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1184 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1185 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1186 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1187 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1189 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1190 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1191 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1192 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1193 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1194 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1195 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1196 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1197 the driver's features in general.
1199 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1200 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1201 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1202 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1205 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1206 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1207 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1208 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1209 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1210 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1212 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1213 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1214 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1215 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1216 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1217 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1219 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1220 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1221 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1224 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1225 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1226 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1227 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1228 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1229 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1230 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1231 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1232 configured to fail the address.
1234 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1235 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1236 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1237 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1238 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1239 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1241 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1242 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1243 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1244 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1245 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1246 the address is bounced.
1250 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1251 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1252 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1253 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1254 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1255 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1256 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1257 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1259 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1260 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1261 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1262 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1263 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1264 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1265 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1266 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1271 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1272 .cindex "router" "running details"
1273 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1274 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1275 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1276 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1277 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1278 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1282 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1283 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1284 original address ceases,
1285 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1286 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1287 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1288 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1289 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1292 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1293 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1294 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1295 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1296 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1298 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1299 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1300 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1301 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1302 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1304 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1305 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1306 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1307 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1308 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1310 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1311 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1312 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1314 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1315 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1316 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1317 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1319 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1320 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1323 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1324 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1325 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1326 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1327 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1329 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1330 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1331 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1332 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1333 facility for this purpose.
1336 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1337 .cindex "case of local parts"
1338 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1339 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1340 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1341 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1342 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1343 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1344 routed addresses are shown.
1348 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1349 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1350 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1351 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1352 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1353 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1356 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1357 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1358 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1359 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1360 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1361 of any other conditions.
1363 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1364 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1365 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1367 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1368 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1369 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1370 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1371 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1373 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1374 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1375 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1376 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1377 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1379 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1380 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1381 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1383 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1384 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1386 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1387 of domains that it defines.
1389 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1390 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1391 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1392 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1393 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1394 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1395 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1396 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1397 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1398 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1400 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1403 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1404 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1405 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1406 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1407 remaining preconditions.
1409 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1410 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1411 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1412 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1413 could lead to confusion.
1415 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1416 set of addresses that it defines.
1418 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1419 specified files is tested.
1421 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1422 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1423 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1424 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1428 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1429 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1430 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1431 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1432 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1433 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1434 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1438 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1439 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1440 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1443 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1444 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1445 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1446 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1447 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1449 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1450 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1452 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1453 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1454 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1455 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1456 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1457 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1460 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1461 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1462 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1463 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1464 processed entirely independently of each other.
1466 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1467 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1468 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1469 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1470 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1471 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1472 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1473 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1474 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1476 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1477 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1478 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1479 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1480 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1481 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1482 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1483 addresses to the same domain.
1485 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1486 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1487 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1488 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1489 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1490 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1491 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1492 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1494 .cindex "queue runner"
1495 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1496 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1497 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1498 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1499 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1500 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1501 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1502 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1503 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1505 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1506 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1507 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1508 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1509 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1510 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1512 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1513 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1514 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1515 messages to other addresses.
1517 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1518 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1519 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1522 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1523 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1524 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1530 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1531 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1532 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1533 .cindex "queue runner"
1534 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1535 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1536 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1537 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1538 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1539 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1540 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1541 passed its retry time.
1542 You can run several queue runners at once.
1544 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1545 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1546 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1547 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1548 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1553 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1554 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1555 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1556 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1557 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1558 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1559 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1560 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1561 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1564 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1565 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1566 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1568 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1569 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1570 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1571 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1572 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1577 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1578 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1579 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1580 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1581 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1582 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1583 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1584 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1585 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1586 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1587 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1589 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1590 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1591 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1594 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1595 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1596 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1597 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1598 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1599 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1600 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1605 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1606 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1607 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1608 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1609 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1610 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1611 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1612 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1621 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1622 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1624 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1625 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1626 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1627 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1630 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1631 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1633 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1634 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1635 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1636 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1640 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1641 following subdirectories are created:
1644 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1645 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1646 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1647 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1648 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1649 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1650 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1653 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1654 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1655 that may be useful to some sites.
1658 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1659 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1660 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1661 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1662 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1663 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1665 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1666 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1667 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1668 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1669 overridden if necessary.
1670 .cindex compiler requirements
1671 .cindex compiler version
1672 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1675 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1676 .cindex "PCRE library"
1677 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1678 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1679 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1680 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1681 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1682 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1683 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1684 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1685 If your operating system has no
1686 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1687 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1688 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1690 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1691 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1692 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1693 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1694 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1695 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1696 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1698 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1699 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1700 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1701 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1702 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1703 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1704 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1705 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1707 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1708 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1709 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1710 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1711 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1712 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1713 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1714 Berkeley DB library.
1716 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1717 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1721 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1722 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1724 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1725 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1726 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1727 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1728 file name is used unmodified.
1730 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1731 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1732 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1733 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1735 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1736 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1737 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1739 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1740 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1741 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1742 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1743 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1744 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1746 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1747 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1748 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1749 operates on a single file.
1753 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1754 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1755 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1756 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1757 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1761 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1762 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1764 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1765 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1766 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1767 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1768 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1769 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1771 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1772 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1773 in one of these lines:
1778 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1779 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1780 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1781 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1784 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1785 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1787 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1788 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1792 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1793 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1794 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1795 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1796 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1797 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1798 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1799 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1800 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1801 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1802 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1803 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1805 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1806 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1807 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1808 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1809 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1810 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1812 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1813 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1814 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1815 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1816 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1817 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1820 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1821 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1822 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1823 facilities, you need to set
1825 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1827 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1828 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1831 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1832 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1833 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1834 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1835 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1836 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1837 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1839 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1840 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1841 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1842 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1843 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1848 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1849 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1851 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1852 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1853 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1854 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1855 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1856 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1857 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1859 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1860 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1861 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1862 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1863 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1867 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1871 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1872 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1873 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1874 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1875 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1876 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1877 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1878 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1879 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1880 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1883 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1884 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1887 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1890 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1892 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1893 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1896 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1897 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1899 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1900 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1903 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1905 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1906 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1910 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1912 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1913 library and include files. For example:
1917 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1920 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1921 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1925 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1928 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1929 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1930 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1935 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1937 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1938 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1939 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1940 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1941 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1942 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1943 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1944 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1945 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1946 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1947 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1948 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1951 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1952 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1953 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1955 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1956 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1958 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1960 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1961 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1962 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1963 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1964 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1965 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1969 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1970 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1971 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1972 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1973 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1974 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1977 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1978 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1979 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1980 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1981 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1983 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1988 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1989 .cindex "lookup modules"
1990 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1991 .cindex ".so building"
1992 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1993 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1995 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1996 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1998 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2000 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2001 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2002 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2003 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2004 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2005 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2007 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2008 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2009 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2018 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2019 .cindex "build directory"
2020 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2021 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2022 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2023 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2024 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2025 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2026 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2028 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2029 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2030 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2031 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2032 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2033 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2034 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2035 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2037 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2038 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2039 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2043 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2044 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2045 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2046 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2047 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2048 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2049 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2053 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2054 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2055 given in addition to the short output.
2059 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2060 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2061 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2062 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2063 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2064 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2065 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2068 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2069 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2071 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2072 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2073 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2074 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2076 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2077 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2078 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2079 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2080 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2081 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2082 and are often not needed.
2084 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2085 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2086 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2087 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2088 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2089 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2090 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2091 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2092 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2095 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2096 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2097 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2098 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2102 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2103 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2104 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2105 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2106 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2107 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2108 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2109 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2110 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2111 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2112 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2113 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2114 containing the lines
2119 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2120 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2122 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2123 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2124 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2127 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2128 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2129 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2130 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2131 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2132 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2133 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2134 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2135 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2136 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2142 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2143 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2144 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2145 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2146 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2147 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2148 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2149 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2152 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2153 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2154 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2155 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2156 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2157 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2158 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2159 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2160 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2161 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2162 syntax. For instance:
2165 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2167 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2168 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2169 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2172 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2173 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2174 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2178 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2179 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2181 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2182 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2183 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2184 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2185 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2186 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2189 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2190 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2192 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2193 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2199 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2200 definition of all three of these variables into your
2201 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2204 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2205 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2206 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2207 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2209 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2210 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2211 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2212 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2213 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2216 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2217 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2218 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2219 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2220 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2223 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2225 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2226 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2227 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2228 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2229 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2230 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2234 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2235 .cindex "building Eximon"
2236 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2237 where the files that are involved are
2239 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2240 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2241 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2242 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2243 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2244 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2246 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2247 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2250 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2251 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2252 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2256 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2257 .cindex "installing Exim"
2258 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2259 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2260 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2261 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2262 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2263 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2264 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2265 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2266 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2267 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2268 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2269 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2271 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2272 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2273 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2274 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2275 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2276 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2277 alternative files, no default is installed.
2279 .cindex "system aliases file"
2280 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2281 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2282 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2283 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2284 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2285 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2286 and outputs a comment to the user.
2288 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2289 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2290 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2291 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2292 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2294 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2295 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2296 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2297 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2298 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2301 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2302 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2305 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2307 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2308 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2309 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2310 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2311 but this usage is deprecated.
2313 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2314 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2315 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2316 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2317 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2318 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2320 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2321 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2322 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2323 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2324 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2325 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2326 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2329 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2330 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2333 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2335 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2336 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2337 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2338 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2341 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2344 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2347 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2348 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2350 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2354 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2356 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2358 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2359 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2360 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2362 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2367 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2368 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2369 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2370 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2371 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2374 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2375 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2376 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2380 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2381 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2382 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2383 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2384 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2390 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2391 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2392 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2393 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2394 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2398 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2399 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2400 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2401 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2402 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2405 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2407 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2409 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2411 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2412 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2413 user agent. For example:
2415 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2416 From: user@your.domain.example
2417 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2418 Subject: Testing Exim
2420 This is a test message.
2423 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2424 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2425 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2427 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2428 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2429 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2430 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2431 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2432 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2434 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2436 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2437 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2438 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2439 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2440 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2442 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2443 .cindex "lock files"
2444 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2445 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2446 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2447 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2448 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2449 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2450 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2451 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2452 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2453 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2454 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2455 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2457 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2458 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2459 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2460 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2461 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2464 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2465 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2466 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2467 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2471 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2472 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2473 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2474 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2475 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2476 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2477 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2478 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2479 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2480 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2481 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2482 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2483 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2485 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2486 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2487 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2488 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2489 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2490 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2493 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2494 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2495 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2496 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2498 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2499 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2500 favourite user agent.
2502 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2503 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2504 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2505 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2506 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2507 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2511 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2512 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2513 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2514 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2515 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2516 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2517 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2518 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2524 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2525 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2526 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2528 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2530 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2531 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2532 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2533 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2534 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2536 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2538 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2540 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2541 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2542 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2550 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2551 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2552 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2553 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2554 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2555 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2556 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2557 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2558 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2561 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2563 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2564 were present before any other options.
2565 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2567 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2568 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2569 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2573 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2574 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2579 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2580 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2583 .cindex "queue runner"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2585 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2586 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2588 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2589 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2590 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2592 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2593 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2594 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2595 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2598 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2599 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2600 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2601 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2602 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2603 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2606 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2607 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2608 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2609 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2610 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2611 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2613 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2614 .cindex "envelope sender"
2615 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2616 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2617 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2618 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2619 users to set envelope senders.
2621 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2622 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2623 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2624 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2625 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2626 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2627 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2629 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2630 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2631 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2632 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2633 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2634 that are available to trusted users.
2636 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2637 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2638 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2639 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2640 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2642 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2643 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2644 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2645 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2647 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2648 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2649 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2650 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2652 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2653 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2658 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2659 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2660 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2667 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2668 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2669 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2670 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2671 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2672 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2673 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2676 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2677 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2678 . creates a man page for the options.
2679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2682 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2689 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2690 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2691 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2692 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2695 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2696 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2697 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2700 .vitem &%--version%&
2701 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2702 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2709 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2712 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2714 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2715 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2716 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2717 clean; it ignores this option.
2722 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2723 .cindex "queue runner"
2724 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2725 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2726 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2728 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2729 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2730 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2731 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2733 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2734 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2735 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2736 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2738 When a listening daemon
2739 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2740 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2741 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2742 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2743 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2744 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2747 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2748 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2749 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2753 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2754 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2755 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2756 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2757 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2758 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2759 because these are reread each time they are used.
2763 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2764 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2768 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2769 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2770 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2771 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2772 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2773 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2775 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2776 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2777 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2778 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2779 test data. A line history is supported.
2781 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2782 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2783 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2784 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2785 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2786 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2787 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2789 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2790 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2791 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2792 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2794 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2795 defined and macros will be expanded.
2796 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2797 available to admin users.
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3053 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3054 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3055 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3056 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3057 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3058 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3060 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3061 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3062 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3063 This option requires admin privileges.
3065 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3066 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3067 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3071 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3072 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3073 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3074 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3075 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3076 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3077 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3079 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3080 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3081 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3082 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3083 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3085 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3086 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3087 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3088 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3093 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3094 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3095 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3096 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3097 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3098 arguments, for example:
3100 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3102 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3103 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3104 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3105 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3106 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3107 users, the output is as in this example:
3109 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3111 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3112 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3114 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3115 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3116 backward compatibility.)
3117 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3118 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3120 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3121 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3122 name will not be output.
3124 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3125 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3126 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3127 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3128 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3129 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3130 written directly into the spool directory.
3132 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3134 exim -bP +local_domains
3136 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3137 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3139 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3141 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3142 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3143 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3144 that driver are output. For example:
3146 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3148 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3149 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3150 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3151 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3152 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3155 .cindex "environment"
3156 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3157 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3160 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3161 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3162 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3163 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3164 The output format is one item per line.
3166 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3167 the exit status will be nonzero.
3172 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3173 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3174 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3175 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3176 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3177 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3178 to allow any user to see the queue.
3180 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3182 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3183 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3186 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3187 .cindex "size" "of message"
3188 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3189 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3190 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3191 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3192 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3193 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3194 before the sender address.
3196 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3197 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3198 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3200 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3201 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3202 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3203 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3204 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3210 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3211 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3212 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3218 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3219 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3220 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3221 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3226 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3227 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3228 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3229 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3233 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3237 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3242 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3243 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3244 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3245 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3250 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3251 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3252 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3253 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3254 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3256 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3257 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3259 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3260 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3261 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3262 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3263 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3264 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3265 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3266 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3267 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3269 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3270 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3275 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3276 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3277 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3278 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3279 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3280 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3281 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3285 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3286 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3287 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3288 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3289 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3290 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3291 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3292 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3293 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3295 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3296 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3297 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3299 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3300 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3301 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3302 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3304 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3305 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3306 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3308 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3309 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3310 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3311 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3312 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3314 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3315 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3319 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3320 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3321 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3322 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3323 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3324 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3325 messages to the MTA.
3328 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3329 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3330 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3331 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3332 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3333 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3334 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3338 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3339 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3340 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3341 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3342 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3343 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3344 the listening daemon.
3348 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3349 .cindex "address" "testing"
3350 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3351 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3352 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3353 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3354 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3356 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3357 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3359 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3360 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3363 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3364 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3365 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3366 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3367 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3370 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3371 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3372 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3373 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3375 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3376 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3377 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3378 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3381 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3382 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3384 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3385 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3386 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3387 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3388 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3389 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3394 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3395 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3396 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3397 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3398 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3399 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3401 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3402 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3403 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3404 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3405 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3406 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3407 dynamic testing facilities.
3411 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3412 .cindex "address" "verification"
3413 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3414 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3415 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3416 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3417 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3418 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3420 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3421 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3422 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3424 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3425 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3427 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3428 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3431 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3432 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3433 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3434 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3435 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3437 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3438 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3439 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3440 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3441 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3442 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3445 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3446 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3447 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3450 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3451 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3452 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3453 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3455 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3456 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3457 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3458 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3462 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3463 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3470 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3471 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3472 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3473 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3475 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3476 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3477 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3478 each port only when the first connection is received.
3480 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3481 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3483 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3485 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3486 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3487 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3488 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3489 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3490 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3491 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3492 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3493 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3495 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3496 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3497 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3498 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3499 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3500 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3501 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3502 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3503 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3505 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3506 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3507 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3508 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3509 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3510 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3511 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3513 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3514 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3515 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3516 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3517 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3518 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3519 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3521 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3522 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3523 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3526 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3527 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3528 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3529 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3530 specified by this option.
3533 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3535 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3536 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3537 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3538 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3539 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3540 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3542 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3543 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3544 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3545 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3546 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3547 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3548 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3550 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3551 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3552 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3558 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3559 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3562 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3564 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3565 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3568 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3570 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3571 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3572 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3573 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3574 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3575 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3576 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3579 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3580 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3581 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3582 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3583 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3584 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3585 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3588 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3589 &`auth `& authenticators
3590 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3591 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3592 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3593 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3594 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3595 &`filter `& filter handling
3596 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3597 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3598 &`ident `& ident lookup
3599 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3600 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3601 &`load `& system load checks
3602 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3603 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3604 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3605 &`memory `& memory handling
3606 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3607 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3608 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3609 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3610 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3611 &`retry `& retry handling
3612 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3613 &`route `& address routing
3614 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3616 &`transport `& transports
3617 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3618 &`verify `& address verification logic
3619 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3621 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3622 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3623 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3624 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3625 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3626 turn everything off.
3628 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3629 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3630 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3631 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3632 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3635 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3636 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3637 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3638 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3639 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3642 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3643 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3646 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3647 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3649 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3651 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3652 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3653 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3654 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3657 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3658 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3659 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3660 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3664 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3665 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3666 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3667 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3668 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3669 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3670 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3671 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3674 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3675 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3676 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3677 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3678 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3680 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3682 .cindex "sender" "name"
3683 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3684 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3685 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3686 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3687 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3688 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3690 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3692 .cindex "sender" "address"
3693 .cindex "address" "sender"
3694 .cindex "trusted users"
3695 .cindex "envelope sender"
3696 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3697 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3698 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3699 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3702 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3703 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3704 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3705 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3708 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3709 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3710 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3711 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3712 examples of shell commands:
3714 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3715 exim -f "" user@domain
3717 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3718 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3721 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3722 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3723 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3724 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3727 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3728 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3729 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3730 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3731 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3732 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3736 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3737 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3739 control = suppress_local_fixups
3741 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3742 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3745 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3748 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3750 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3751 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3752 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3757 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3758 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3759 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3760 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3761 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3762 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3764 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3766 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3767 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3768 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3769 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3770 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3771 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3773 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3775 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3777 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3778 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3779 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3780 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3781 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3782 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3783 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3786 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3787 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3788 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3789 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3790 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3791 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3793 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3794 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3795 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3796 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3798 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3800 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3801 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3802 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3803 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3804 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3805 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3806 can be used only by an admin user.
3808 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3809 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3811 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3812 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3813 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3814 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3815 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3816 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3817 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3818 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3824 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3828 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3829 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3830 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3832 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3834 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3835 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3836 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3840 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3841 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3842 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3846 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3847 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3848 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3850 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3852 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3853 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3854 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3855 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3856 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3857 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3861 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3863 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3868 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3869 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3870 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3872 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3874 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3875 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3876 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3877 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3879 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3881 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3882 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3883 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3884 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3885 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3886 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3887 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3888 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3889 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3890 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3891 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3892 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3893 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3895 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3897 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3898 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3899 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3900 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3901 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3902 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3903 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3904 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3906 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3908 .cindex "freezing messages"
3909 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3910 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3911 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3912 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3913 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3914 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3917 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3919 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3920 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3921 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3922 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3923 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3924 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3925 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3926 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3929 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3931 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3932 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3933 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3934 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3935 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3937 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3939 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3940 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3941 .cindex "removing recipients"
3942 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3943 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3944 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3945 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3946 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3947 can be used only by an admin user.
3949 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3951 .cindex "removing messages"
3952 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3953 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3954 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3955 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3956 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3957 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3958 placed on the queue.
3960 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3962 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3963 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3964 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3965 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3966 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3967 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3968 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3969 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3970 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3972 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3974 .cindex "thawing messages"
3975 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3976 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3977 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3978 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3979 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3980 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3983 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3985 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3986 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3987 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3988 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3990 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3992 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3993 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3994 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3995 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3996 only by an admin user.
3998 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4000 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4001 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4002 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4003 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4004 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4006 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4008 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4009 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4010 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4011 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4015 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4016 treats it that way too.
4020 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4021 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4022 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4023 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4024 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4025 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4026 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4029 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4030 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4031 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4032 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4033 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4034 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4035 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4040 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4041 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4042 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4043 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4045 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4047 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4050 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4052 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4053 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4054 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4057 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4059 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4060 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4061 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4062 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4063 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4064 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4068 .cindex "background delivery"
4069 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4070 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4071 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4072 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4073 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4074 processes to finish.
4076 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4077 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4078 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4079 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4081 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4082 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4083 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4084 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4088 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4089 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4090 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4091 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4092 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4093 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4095 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4096 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4099 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4100 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4102 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4103 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4104 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4105 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4110 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4115 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4116 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4117 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4118 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4119 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4120 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4121 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4122 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4123 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4124 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4129 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4130 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4131 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4132 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4133 configuration file is in effect.
4135 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4136 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4137 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4138 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4139 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4140 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4141 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4142 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4143 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4148 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4149 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4150 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4153 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4155 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4156 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4157 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4158 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4162 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4163 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4164 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4165 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4166 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4170 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4171 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4172 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4173 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4174 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4178 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4179 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4184 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4185 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4190 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4191 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4192 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4193 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4194 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4195 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4198 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4199 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4201 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4203 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4204 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4205 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4206 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4207 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4208 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4210 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4211 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4213 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4215 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4216 followed by a colon and the port number:
4218 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4220 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4221 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4222 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4223 whichever one is last.
4225 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4227 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4228 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4229 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4230 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4231 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4232 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4234 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4236 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4238 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4239 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4240 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4241 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4243 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4245 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4246 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4247 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4248 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4249 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4250 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4251 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4252 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4254 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4256 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4257 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4258 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4259 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4260 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4262 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4264 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4265 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4266 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4267 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4268 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4269 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4270 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4272 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4273 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4274 is sending the bounce.
4276 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4278 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4279 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4280 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4281 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4282 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4283 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4284 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4285 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4286 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4287 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4289 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4291 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4292 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4293 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4294 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4295 uses the name it is given.
4297 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4299 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4300 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4301 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4302 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4303 used, when there is no default.
4307 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4308 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4309 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4310 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4314 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4315 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4316 whatever that means.
4318 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4320 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4321 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4322 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4323 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4324 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4325 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4326 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4328 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4330 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4331 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4332 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4333 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4334 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4336 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4338 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4339 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4340 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4341 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4342 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4343 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4347 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4349 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4351 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4352 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4353 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4354 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4355 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4356 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4357 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4358 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4362 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4363 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4364 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4365 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4370 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4371 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4372 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4373 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4376 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4378 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4380 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4382 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4383 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4384 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4385 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4386 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4387 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4391 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4392 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4393 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4394 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4395 and &%-S%& options).
4397 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4398 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4399 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4400 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4401 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4402 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4403 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4406 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4407 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4408 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4409 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4410 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4413 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4414 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4415 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4416 this to be repeated periodically.
4418 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4419 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4420 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4421 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4423 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4424 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4425 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4427 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4428 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4429 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4430 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4434 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4435 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4436 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4437 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4438 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4439 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4442 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4443 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4444 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4445 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4446 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4447 delivered down a single SMTP
4448 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4449 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4450 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4451 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4452 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4455 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4457 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4458 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4459 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4460 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4461 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4463 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4465 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4466 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4467 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4468 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4469 their retry times are tried.
4471 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4473 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4474 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4477 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4479 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4480 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4481 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4484 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4487 .cindex "named queues"
4488 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4489 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4490 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4491 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4492 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4493 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4495 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4496 will specify a queue to operate on.
4499 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4501 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4504 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4505 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4506 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4507 starting message id. For example:
4509 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4511 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4512 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4513 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4515 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4517 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4518 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4519 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4520 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4521 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4522 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4524 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4525 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4526 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4527 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4528 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4529 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4530 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4531 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4532 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4534 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4536 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4537 process every 30 minutes.
4539 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4540 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4542 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4544 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4547 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4549 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4551 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4553 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4554 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4555 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4556 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4557 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4558 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4559 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4561 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4562 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4563 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4564 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4565 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4566 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4568 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4569 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4571 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4573 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4574 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4575 applied to each queue run.
4577 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4578 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4579 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4580 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4581 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4582 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4583 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4584 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4585 address will be skipped.
4587 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4588 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4589 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4592 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4593 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4594 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4595 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4596 an arbitrary command instead.
4600 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4602 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4604 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4605 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4606 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4607 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4608 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4609 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4611 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4613 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4614 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4615 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4619 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4620 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4621 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4622 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4623 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4624 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4625 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4626 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4627 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4629 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4630 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4631 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4632 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4633 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4634 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4635 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4636 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4637 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4638 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4639 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4641 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4642 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4643 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4644 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4645 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4646 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4648 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4649 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4650 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4651 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4652 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4653 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4654 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4655 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4656 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4660 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4661 compatibility with Sendmail.
4663 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4664 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4665 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4666 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4667 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4668 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4669 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4670 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4675 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4676 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4677 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4678 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4679 set. Exim ignores this option.
4683 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4684 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4685 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4686 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4687 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4688 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4693 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4694 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4695 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4698 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4700 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4701 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4703 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4705 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4706 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4707 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4716 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4717 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4718 . creates a man page for the options.
4719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4722 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4733 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4734 "The runtime configuration file"
4736 .cindex "run time configuration"
4737 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4738 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4739 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4740 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4741 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4742 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4743 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4744 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4747 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4748 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4749 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4750 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4751 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4752 actually alter the string.
4754 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4755 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4756 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4757 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4758 existing file in the list.
4761 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4762 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4763 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4764 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4765 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4766 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4767 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4768 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4769 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4770 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4772 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4773 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4774 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4775 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4776 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4778 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4779 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4780 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4781 compromise the Exim user account.
4783 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4784 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4785 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4786 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4787 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4788 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4793 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4794 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4795 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4796 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4797 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4798 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4799 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4800 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4801 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4802 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4803 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4805 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4806 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4807 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4808 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4809 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4810 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4811 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4812 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4813 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4816 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4817 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4818 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4819 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4820 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4822 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4823 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4824 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4825 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4826 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4827 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4829 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4830 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4831 necessarily be discarded.
4832 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4833 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4834 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4835 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4836 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4837 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4839 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4840 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4841 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4842 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4843 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4844 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4845 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4847 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4848 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4849 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4853 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4854 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4855 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4856 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4857 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4858 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4859 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4860 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4863 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4866 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4867 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4868 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4870 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4871 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4872 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4874 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4875 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4876 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4878 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4879 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4880 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4881 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4884 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4885 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4886 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4888 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4889 want to use this feature, you must set
4891 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4893 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4894 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4897 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4898 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4899 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4900 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4902 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4903 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4904 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4905 and does not introduce a comment.
4907 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4908 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4909 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4910 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4911 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4913 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4914 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4915 change settings as required.
4917 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4918 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4919 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4920 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4921 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4926 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4927 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4928 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4929 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4930 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4931 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4934 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4935 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4937 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4938 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4939 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4940 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4941 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4944 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4945 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4946 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4947 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4949 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4950 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4953 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4956 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4957 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4962 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4963 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4964 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4965 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4966 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4967 definition, and must be of the form
4969 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4971 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4972 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4973 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4974 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4975 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4977 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4978 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4979 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4981 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4982 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4983 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4984 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4985 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4986 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4987 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4990 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4991 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4993 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4994 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4995 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4996 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4997 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4998 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5001 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5002 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5003 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5008 MAC == updated value
5010 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5011 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5012 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5013 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5017 MAC == MAC and something added
5019 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5020 from a number of other files.
5022 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5023 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5024 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5025 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5026 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5031 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5032 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5033 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5034 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5036 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5037 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5039 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5041 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5043 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5044 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5045 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5048 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5049 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5050 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5051 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5052 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5055 The following classes of macros are defined:
5057 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5058 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5059 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5060 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5061 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5062 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5063 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5064 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5065 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5066 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5067 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5070 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5073 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5074 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5075 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5076 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5077 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5078 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5079 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5081 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5082 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5083 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5087 message_size_limit = 50M
5089 message_size_limit = 100M
5092 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5093 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5094 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5095 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5096 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5098 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5099 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5100 in this line"& will always be true.
5102 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5103 to clarify complicated nestings.
5107 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5108 .cindex "common option syntax"
5109 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5110 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5111 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5112 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5113 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5114 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5115 space) and then the value. For example:
5117 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5119 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5120 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5121 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5122 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5123 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5124 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5125 word &"hide"&. For example:
5127 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5129 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5131 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5133 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5134 all instances of the same driver.
5136 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5137 that are found in option settings.
5140 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5141 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5142 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5143 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5144 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5145 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5146 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5147 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5148 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5149 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5150 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5151 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5156 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5161 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5166 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5167 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5168 .cindex "format" "integer"
5169 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5170 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5171 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5172 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5175 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5176 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5177 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5179 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5180 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5181 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5185 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5186 .cindex "integer format"
5187 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5188 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5189 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5190 Such options are always output in octal.
5193 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5194 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5195 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5196 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5197 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5201 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5202 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5203 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5204 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5205 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5215 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5216 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5217 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5221 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5222 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5223 .cindex "format" "string"
5224 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5225 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5226 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5227 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5228 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5229 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5230 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5231 therefore equivalent:
5233 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5234 trusted_users = uucp:\
5235 # This comment line is ignored
5238 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5239 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5240 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5241 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5242 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5245 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5246 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5247 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5249 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5250 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5254 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5255 character, that character replaces the pair.
5257 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5258 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5259 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5260 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5261 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5262 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5265 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5266 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5267 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5268 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5269 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5270 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5271 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5272 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5273 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5274 within a quoted configuration string.
5277 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5278 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5279 .cindex "format" "user name"
5280 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5281 .cindex "format" "group name"
5282 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5283 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5284 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5285 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5288 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5289 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5290 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5291 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5292 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5293 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5294 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5295 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5296 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5297 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5298 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5300 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5301 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5302 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5303 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5304 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5305 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5308 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5310 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5312 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5313 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5314 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5315 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5317 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5318 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5319 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5320 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5321 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5322 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5323 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5324 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5326 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5328 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5329 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5330 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5332 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5333 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5334 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5335 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5336 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5337 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5338 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5339 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5340 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5342 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5344 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5345 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5346 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5347 the value in quotes. For example:
5349 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5351 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5352 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5353 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5354 enclosing an empty list item.
5358 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5359 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5360 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5361 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5363 senders = user@domain :
5365 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5366 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5367 items, the second of which is empty:
5369 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5371 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5372 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5373 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5374 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5378 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5379 is at the end of the list.
5384 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5385 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5386 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5387 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5388 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5389 a sequence of lines like this:
5391 <&'instance name'&>:
5396 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5397 followed by three options settings:
5402 transport = local_delivery
5404 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5405 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5406 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5407 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5408 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5409 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5411 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5412 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5414 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5415 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5416 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5417 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5418 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5421 .cindex "generic options"
5422 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5423 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5424 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5425 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5426 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5427 .cindex "private options"
5428 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5429 they all have default values.
5431 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5432 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5433 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5435 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5436 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5437 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5438 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5439 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5440 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5441 configuration lines:
5446 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5447 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5448 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5449 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5455 command_timeout = 10s
5457 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5458 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5461 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5462 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5463 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5474 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5475 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5476 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5477 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5478 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5479 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5480 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5481 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5482 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5483 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5484 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5488 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5489 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5490 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5493 # primary_hostname =
5495 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5496 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5497 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5498 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5500 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5502 domainlist local_domains = @
5503 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5504 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5506 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5507 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5508 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5509 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5511 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5512 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5515 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5516 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5517 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5518 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5519 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5520 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5522 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5523 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5524 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5525 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5526 domain is permitted.
5528 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5529 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5530 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5531 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5532 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5533 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5535 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5536 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5537 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5539 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5541 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5542 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5544 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5545 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5546 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5547 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5548 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5549 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5550 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5551 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5552 contents of a message to be checked.
5554 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5556 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5557 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5559 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5560 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5561 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5562 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5564 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5566 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5567 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5568 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5570 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5571 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5572 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5573 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5574 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5575 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5576 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5578 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5580 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5581 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5583 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5584 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5585 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5586 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5587 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5588 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5589 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5590 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5591 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5592 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5593 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5594 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5595 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5596 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5597 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5598 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5600 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5601 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5602 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5603 which should be used in preference to 587.
5604 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5606 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5608 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5611 # qualify_recipient =
5613 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5614 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5615 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5616 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5617 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5618 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5620 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5621 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5622 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5623 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5625 # allow_domain_literals
5627 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5628 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5629 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5630 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5631 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5632 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5634 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5638 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5639 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5640 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5641 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5642 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5643 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5644 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5645 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5647 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5648 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5653 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5654 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5655 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5656 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5657 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5658 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5661 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5662 1413 (hence their names):
5665 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5667 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5668 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5669 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5670 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5671 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5672 information, you can change this.
5674 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5675 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5680 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5681 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5682 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5683 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5685 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5686 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5688 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5689 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5691 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5694 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5695 +tls_certificate_verified
5698 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5700 # percent_hack_domains =
5702 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5703 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5704 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5706 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5707 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5708 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5709 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5710 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5711 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5712 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5713 always bounce messages.
5715 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5716 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5718 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5719 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5720 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5721 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5722 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5724 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5725 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5726 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5727 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5728 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5731 # split_spool_directory = true
5734 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5735 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5736 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5737 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5738 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5739 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5740 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5742 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5745 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5746 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5747 that are not 8-bit clean.
5749 # accept_8bitmime = false
5752 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5753 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5754 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5755 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5756 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5757 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5759 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5760 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5764 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5765 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5766 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5767 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5768 It starts with the line
5772 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5773 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5774 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5776 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5777 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5778 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5779 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5780 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5781 result of the ACL processing.
5785 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5790 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5791 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5792 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5793 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5794 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5795 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5797 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5798 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5799 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5802 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5803 domains = +local_domains
5804 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5806 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5807 domains = !+local_domains
5808 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5810 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5811 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5812 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5813 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5814 in Internet mail addresses.
5816 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5817 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5818 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5819 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5820 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5821 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5822 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5823 policy of being as safe as possible.
5825 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5826 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5827 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5828 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5829 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5830 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5832 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5833 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5834 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5835 have to modify this rule.
5837 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5838 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5839 common convention of local parts constructed as
5840 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5841 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5842 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5843 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5844 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5845 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5847 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5848 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5849 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5850 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5851 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5852 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5853 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5855 accept local_parts = postmaster
5856 domains = +local_domains
5858 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5859 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5860 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5861 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5862 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5864 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5865 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5866 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5868 require verify = sender
5870 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5871 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5872 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5873 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5874 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5875 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5876 discusses the details of address verification.
5878 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5879 control = submission
5881 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5882 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5883 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5884 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5885 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5886 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5887 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5888 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5889 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5891 accept authenticated = *
5892 control = submission
5894 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5895 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5896 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5897 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5898 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5899 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5901 require message = relay not permitted
5902 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5904 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5905 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5907 require verify = recipient
5909 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5910 fails, the address is rejected.
5912 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5913 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5915 # dnslists = black.list.example
5917 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5918 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5919 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5920 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5922 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5923 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5924 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5927 # require verify = csa
5929 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5930 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5935 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5936 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5940 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5941 of this ACL are commented out:
5944 # message = This message contains a virus \
5947 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5948 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5949 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5950 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5952 # warn spam = nobody
5953 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5954 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5955 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5956 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5958 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5959 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5960 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5961 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5962 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5963 whatever the spam score.
5967 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5970 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5971 .cindex "default" "routers"
5972 .cindex "routers" "default"
5973 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5978 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5979 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5980 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5981 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5982 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5985 # driver = ipliteral
5986 # domains = !+local_domains
5987 # transport = remote_smtp
5989 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5990 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5991 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5992 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5993 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5997 domains = ! +local_domains
5998 transport = remote_smtp
5999 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6002 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
6003 domains. This is specified by the line
6005 domains = ! +local_domains
6007 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6008 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6009 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6010 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6011 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6012 passed on to the following routers.
6014 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6015 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6016 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6017 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6018 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6020 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6021 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6022 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6023 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6024 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6025 the address fails and is bounced.
6027 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6028 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6029 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6030 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6031 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6032 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6033 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6040 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6042 file_transport = address_file
6043 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6045 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6046 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6047 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6048 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6049 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6052 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6053 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6054 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6055 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6060 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6061 # local_part_suffix_optional
6062 file = $home/.forward
6067 file_transport = address_file
6068 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6069 reply_transport = address_reply
6071 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6072 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6073 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6074 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6075 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6078 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6079 # local_part_suffix_optional
6081 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6082 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6083 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6084 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6085 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6086 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6087 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6089 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6090 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6091 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6092 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6094 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6095 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6096 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6097 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6098 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6099 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6100 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6102 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6103 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6104 There are two reasons for doing this:
6107 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6108 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6111 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6112 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6113 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6114 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6118 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6119 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6120 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6121 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6123 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6124 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6125 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6127 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6129 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6135 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6136 # local_part_suffix_optional
6137 transport = local_delivery
6139 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6140 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6141 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6142 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6143 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6146 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6147 .cindex "default" "transports"
6148 .cindex "transports" "default"
6149 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6150 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6151 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6155 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6161 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6162 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6163 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6164 It is negotiated between client and server
6165 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6166 All other options are defaulted.
6170 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6177 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6178 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6179 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6180 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6181 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6182 show how this can be done.
6184 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6185 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6186 similarly-named options above.
6192 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6193 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6194 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6195 be returned to the sender.
6203 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6204 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6205 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6210 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6215 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6216 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6217 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6218 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6219 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6220 introduced by the line
6224 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6227 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6229 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6230 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6231 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6232 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6233 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6235 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6236 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6237 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6240 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6241 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6245 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6246 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6250 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6251 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6252 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6254 begin authenticators
6256 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6257 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6258 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6259 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6260 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6261 to support most MUA software.
6263 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6266 # driver = plaintext
6267 # server_set_id = $auth2
6268 # server_prompts = :
6269 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6270 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6272 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6275 # driver = plaintext
6276 # server_set_id = $auth1
6277 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6278 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6279 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6282 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6283 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6284 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6285 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6286 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6287 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6288 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6289 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6291 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6292 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6293 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6294 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6296 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6297 usercode and password are in different positions.
6298 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6300 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6307 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6309 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6311 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6312 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6313 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6314 regular expressions is discussed in
6315 online Perl manpages, in
6316 many Perl reference books, and also in
6317 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6318 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6320 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6321 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6322 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6323 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6324 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6327 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6328 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6329 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6330 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6332 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6334 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6335 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6336 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6337 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6338 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6339 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6342 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6343 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6344 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6345 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6346 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6347 match anywhere in the subject string.
6349 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6350 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6352 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6354 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6357 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6359 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6360 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6367 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6368 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6369 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6370 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6371 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6372 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6375 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6376 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6377 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6378 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6379 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6380 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6382 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6383 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6384 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6385 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6386 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6387 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6390 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6391 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6392 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6393 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6394 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6395 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6397 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6398 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6399 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6400 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6401 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6403 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6404 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6406 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6407 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6408 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6409 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6410 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6412 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6413 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6415 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6416 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6418 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6419 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6420 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6425 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6426 matches the list item.
6428 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6429 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6431 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6433 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6434 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6435 causes a second lookup to occur.
6437 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6438 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6439 lookup is permitted.
6442 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6443 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6444 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6445 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6448 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6449 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6450 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6452 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6453 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6454 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6455 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6458 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6459 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6460 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6465 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6466 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6467 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6472 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6473 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6474 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6475 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6478 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6479 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6480 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6481 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6482 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6483 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6484 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6485 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6486 be found in several places:
6488 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6489 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6490 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6492 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6493 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6494 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6495 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6497 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6498 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6499 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6500 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6501 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6502 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6503 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6505 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6506 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6507 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6508 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6509 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6510 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6511 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6513 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6514 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6516 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6517 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6518 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6519 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6520 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6521 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6522 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6524 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6525 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6526 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6528 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6529 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6530 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6531 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6532 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6533 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6534 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6535 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6536 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6537 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6539 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6540 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6541 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6542 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6543 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6544 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6545 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6546 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6547 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6549 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6550 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6551 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6552 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6553 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6554 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6555 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6557 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6558 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6559 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6560 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6562 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6563 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6564 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6565 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6566 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6568 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6569 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6570 lookup types support only literal keys.
6572 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6573 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6574 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6576 .cindex "linear search"
6577 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6578 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6579 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6580 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6581 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6582 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6583 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6584 in the file is used.
6586 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6587 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6588 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6589 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6590 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6595 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6596 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6597 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6598 wildcarding of any kind.
6600 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6601 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6602 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6603 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6604 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6605 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6606 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6607 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6608 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6611 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6612 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6613 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6614 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6615 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6616 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6617 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6618 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6621 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6622 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6623 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6624 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6625 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6626 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6627 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6628 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6629 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6631 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6632 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6633 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6634 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6636 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6637 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6640 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6642 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6643 *fish data for anythingfish
6646 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6647 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6649 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6651 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6652 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6653 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6655 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6657 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6658 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6659 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6661 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6664 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6665 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6666 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6667 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6668 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6670 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6671 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6672 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6673 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6674 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6677 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6678 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6679 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6682 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6684 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6687 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6688 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6689 be followed by optional colons.
6691 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6692 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6693 lookup types support only literal keys.
6697 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6698 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6699 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6700 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6701 many of them are given in later sections.
6704 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6705 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6706 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6707 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6708 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6710 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6711 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6712 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6714 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6715 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6716 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6717 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6718 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6719 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6720 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6722 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6723 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6724 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6725 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6727 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6728 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6729 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6730 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6732 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6733 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6734 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6735 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6737 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6738 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6739 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6740 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6741 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6742 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6743 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6744 password value. For example:
6746 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6749 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6750 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6751 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6752 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6755 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6756 .cindex lookup Redis
6757 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6758 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6761 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6762 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6763 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6764 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6767 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6768 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6770 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6771 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6772 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6773 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6774 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6775 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6776 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6777 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6778 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6780 require condition = \
6781 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6783 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6784 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6785 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6786 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6791 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6792 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6793 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6794 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6795 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6796 options such as a list of local domains.
6798 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6799 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6800 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6801 or may give up altogether.
6805 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6806 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6807 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6808 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6809 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6810 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6811 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6812 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6814 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6815 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6816 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6818 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6819 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6820 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6822 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6823 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6824 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6825 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6826 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6827 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6828 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6829 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6830 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6831 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6833 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6835 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6836 looks up these keys, in this order:
6842 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6843 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6844 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6845 Exim move on to try the next key.
6849 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6850 .cindex "partial matching"
6851 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6852 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6853 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6854 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6855 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6856 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6857 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6858 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6859 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6860 a key in a DBM file is
6862 *.dates.fict.example
6864 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6865 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6866 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6869 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6870 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6871 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6873 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6874 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6875 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6876 partial matching keys
6877 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6878 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6879 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6881 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6882 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6883 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6884 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6885 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6886 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6889 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6890 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6891 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6892 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6893 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6894 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6896 2250.dates.fict.example
6897 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6898 *.dates.fict.example
6901 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6904 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6905 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6906 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6907 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6908 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6909 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6911 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6913 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6914 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6915 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6916 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6918 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6920 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6921 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6923 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6924 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6925 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6928 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6930 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6931 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6933 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6934 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6935 for &"*"& on its own.
6937 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6941 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6942 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6943 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6944 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6945 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6946 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6947 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6949 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6950 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6951 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6952 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6953 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6958 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6959 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6960 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6961 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6962 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6963 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6964 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6966 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6967 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6968 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6969 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6970 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6971 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6973 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6974 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6980 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6981 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6982 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6983 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6984 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6985 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6989 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6990 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6992 [name="$local_part"]
6994 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6995 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6996 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6997 of the following form is provided:
6999 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7001 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7003 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7005 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7006 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7007 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7012 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7013 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7014 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7015 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7016 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7017 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7018 an expansion string could contain:
7020 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7022 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7023 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7024 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7025 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7027 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7028 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7029 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7031 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7032 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7033 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7034 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7035 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7037 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7039 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7040 white space is ignored.
7041 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7042 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7043 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7045 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7046 When the type is PTR,
7047 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7048 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7050 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7052 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7053 altered and nothing is added.
7055 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7056 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7057 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7058 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7059 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7060 The field separator can be modified as above.
7062 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7063 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7064 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7065 unless a field separator is specified.
7066 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7068 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7070 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7071 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7072 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7074 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7075 white space is ignored.
7077 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7078 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7079 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7080 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7083 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7086 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7087 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7088 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7089 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7090 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7091 each followed by a comma,
7092 that may appear before the record type.
7094 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7095 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7096 a defer-option modifier.
7097 The possible keywords are
7098 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7099 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7100 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7101 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7102 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7103 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7104 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7106 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7107 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7109 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7110 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7112 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7113 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7114 The possible keywords are
7115 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7116 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7118 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7119 is not labelled as authenticated data
7120 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7121 The default is &"never"&.
7123 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7125 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7126 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7127 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7128 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7130 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7132 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7133 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7134 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7136 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7137 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7139 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7140 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7141 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7144 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7145 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7146 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7147 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7148 the pseudo-type MXH:
7150 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7152 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7155 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7156 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7157 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7158 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7159 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7160 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7161 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7162 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7164 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7165 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7167 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7168 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7169 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7171 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7172 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7173 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7174 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7175 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7178 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7179 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7180 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7181 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7182 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7183 result of a successful lookup such as:
7185 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7187 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7188 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7189 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7191 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7192 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7193 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7194 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7196 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7200 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7201 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7202 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7203 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7204 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7206 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7207 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7208 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7210 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7211 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7212 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7213 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7215 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7216 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7217 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7222 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7223 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7224 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7225 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7226 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7227 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7228 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7229 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7230 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7231 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7232 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7233 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7235 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7236 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7237 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7238 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7239 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7241 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7242 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7244 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7245 the way they handle the results of a query:
7248 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7251 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7252 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7254 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7255 from all of them are returned.
7259 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7260 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7261 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7262 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7265 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7266 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7267 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7268 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7270 data = ${lookup ldap \
7271 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7272 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7274 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7275 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7276 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7277 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7279 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7280 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7281 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7283 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7284 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7285 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7286 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7287 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7288 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7289 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7290 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7294 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7295 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7296 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7297 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7298 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7299 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7301 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7302 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7310 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7311 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7315 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7317 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7321 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7323 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7325 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7327 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7328 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7329 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7333 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7334 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7335 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7337 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7341 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7343 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7345 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7347 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7348 authentication below.
7351 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7352 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7353 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7354 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7355 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7358 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7360 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7361 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7362 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7363 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7364 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7365 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7366 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7367 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7368 failures, and timeouts.
7370 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7371 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7372 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7373 doubled. For example
7375 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7377 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7378 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7379 the local host) is used.
7381 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7382 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7383 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7384 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7387 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7388 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7389 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7390 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7392 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7394 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7395 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7397 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7399 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7400 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7401 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7402 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7403 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7404 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7405 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7408 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7409 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7410 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7413 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7416 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7420 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7421 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7425 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7426 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7427 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7428 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7429 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7430 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7431 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7432 them. The following names are recognized:
7434 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7435 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7436 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7437 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7438 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7439 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7440 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7441 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7443 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7444 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7445 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7446 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7448 .cindex LDAP timeout
7449 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7450 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7451 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7452 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7453 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7454 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7455 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7456 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7457 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7458 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7460 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7461 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7463 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7464 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7465 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7466 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7467 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7468 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7469 alternate list (colon-separated).
7471 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7472 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7475 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7476 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7479 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7480 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7481 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7482 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7484 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7485 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7486 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7488 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7489 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7490 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7491 quoting has two advantages:
7494 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7495 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7497 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7500 For example, a setting such as
7502 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7504 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7506 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7507 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7508 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7509 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7513 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7514 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7519 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7520 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7521 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7522 as a sequence of values, for example
7524 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7526 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7527 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7528 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7529 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7530 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7533 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7534 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7535 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7536 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7538 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7539 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7540 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7541 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7542 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7543 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7544 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7545 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7546 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7548 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7549 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7550 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7551 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7552 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7555 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7558 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7561 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7562 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7564 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7565 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7567 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7568 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7571 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7572 results of LDAP lookups.
7573 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7574 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7575 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7576 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7577 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7578 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7583 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7584 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7585 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7586 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7587 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7588 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7589 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7590 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7592 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7594 might return the string
7596 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7597 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7599 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7601 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7607 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7608 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7609 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7613 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7614 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7615 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7616 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7617 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7618 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7619 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7620 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7621 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7622 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7623 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7624 .cindex lookup Redis
7625 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7627 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7630 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7633 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7634 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7636 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7641 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7643 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7644 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7645 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7649 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7650 with a newline between the data for each row.
7653 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7654 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7655 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7656 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7657 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7658 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7659 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7660 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7661 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7662 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7663 .cindex lookup Redis
7664 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7665 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7666 or &%redis_servers%&
7667 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7669 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7670 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7671 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7673 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7674 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7675 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7676 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7678 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7680 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7681 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7682 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7684 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7685 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7687 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7688 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7689 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7690 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7691 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7692 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7694 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7695 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7696 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7698 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7699 host, database number, and password.
7701 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7702 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7703 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7705 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7707 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7710 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7711 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7712 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7713 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7715 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7716 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7718 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7719 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7720 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7721 done by starting the query with
7723 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7725 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7727 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7728 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7729 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7732 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7734 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7735 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7736 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7738 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7739 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7740 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7743 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7747 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7749 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7751 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7752 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7753 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7755 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7759 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7760 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7761 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7762 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7763 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7764 the default value is &"exim"&.
7765 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7767 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7768 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7770 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7771 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7773 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7776 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7777 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7779 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7780 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7781 is zero because no rows are affected.
7784 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7785 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7786 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7787 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7788 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7791 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7793 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7794 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7795 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7797 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7798 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7801 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7802 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7803 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7804 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7805 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7806 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7807 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7808 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7809 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7811 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7812 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7814 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7816 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7817 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7819 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7820 quote, which it doubles.
7822 .cindex timeout SQLite
7823 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7824 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7825 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7826 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7827 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7828 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7829 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7832 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7833 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7834 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7835 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7838 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7839 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7846 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7847 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7849 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7850 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7851 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7852 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7853 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7854 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7855 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7856 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7857 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7859 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7860 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7861 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7862 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7864 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7865 support all the complexity available in
7866 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7870 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7871 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7872 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7874 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7875 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7878 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7879 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7880 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7881 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7882 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7885 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7886 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7887 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7889 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7890 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7891 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7892 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7893 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7895 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7896 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7898 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7899 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7900 senders based on the receiving domain.
7905 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7906 .cindex "list" "negation"
7907 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7908 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7909 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7910 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7911 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7912 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7914 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7915 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7916 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7917 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7918 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7920 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7922 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7923 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7924 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7926 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7928 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7929 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7930 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7932 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7933 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7938 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7939 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7940 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7941 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7942 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7943 file names are not allowed,
7944 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7945 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7949 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7950 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7952 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7953 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7954 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7956 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7960 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7961 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7962 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7963 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7965 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7966 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7968 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7970 and the file contains the lines
7975 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7976 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7980 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7981 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7982 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7983 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7984 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7985 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7986 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7987 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7989 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7990 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7991 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7992 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7997 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7998 .cindex "named lists"
7999 .cindex "list" "named"
8000 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8001 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8002 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8003 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8004 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8005 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8006 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8008 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8010 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8011 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8012 configured with the line
8014 domains = +local_domains
8016 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8017 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8021 domains = ! +local_domains
8022 transport = remote_smtp
8025 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8026 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8027 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8028 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8030 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8031 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8033 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8035 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8036 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8037 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8039 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8040 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8041 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8043 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8044 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8046 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8047 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8048 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8050 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8052 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8053 referenced lists if you can.
8055 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8056 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8057 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8059 domains = +local_domains
8061 on several of your routers
8062 or in several ACL statements,
8063 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8064 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8065 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8066 the same each time they are referenced.
8068 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8069 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8070 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8071 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8075 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8076 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8077 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8078 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8079 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8082 ALIST = host1 : host2
8083 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8085 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8087 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8089 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8092 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8093 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8095 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8097 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8101 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8102 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8103 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8104 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8105 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8106 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8107 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8108 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8109 message. For example:
8111 domainlist special_domains = \
8112 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8114 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8115 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8116 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8117 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8118 same list each time.
8120 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8121 cache the result anyway. For example:
8123 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8125 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8126 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8130 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8131 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8132 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8133 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8134 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8137 .cindex "primary host name"
8138 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8139 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8140 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8141 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8142 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8143 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8144 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8145 differ only in their names.
8147 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8148 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8149 .cindex "domain literal"
8150 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8151 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8152 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8153 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8154 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8155 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8158 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8159 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8160 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8161 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8162 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8163 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8164 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8165 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8166 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8167 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8168 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8170 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8171 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8172 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8173 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8174 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8176 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8177 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8178 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8179 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8180 on a router). For example:
8182 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8184 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8185 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8187 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8188 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8189 contain negative items.
8191 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8192 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8193 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8195 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8196 an.other.domain : ...
8198 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8199 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8201 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8202 an.other.domain ? ...
8205 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8206 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8207 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8208 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8209 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8210 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8211 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8212 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8213 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8217 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8218 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8219 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8220 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8221 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8222 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8223 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8224 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8225 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8227 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8228 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8229 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8230 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8231 expression by expansion, of course).
8233 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8234 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8235 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8236 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8237 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8238 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8240 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8242 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8243 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8244 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8245 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8246 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8247 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8248 other statements in the same ACL.
8251 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8252 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8254 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8256 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8257 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8260 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8261 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8262 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8263 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8264 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8265 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8268 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8269 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8270 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8271 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8273 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8274 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8276 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8277 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8278 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8279 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8280 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8282 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8283 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8284 between the pattern and the domain.
8287 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8289 domainlist funny_domains = \
8292 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8293 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8294 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8295 nis;domains.byname : \
8296 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8298 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8299 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8300 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8301 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8302 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8307 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8308 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8309 .cindex "list" "host list"
8310 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8311 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8312 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8313 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8314 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8315 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8316 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8319 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8320 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8321 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8322 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8323 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8324 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8327 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8328 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8329 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8333 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8334 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8335 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8336 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8337 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8338 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8339 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8342 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8343 inspecting its IP address:
8346 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8347 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8348 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8349 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8350 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8351 with the IP address of the subject host.
8353 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8354 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8355 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8356 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8357 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8360 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8361 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8362 domain name, as just described.
8365 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8366 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8367 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8368 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8369 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8370 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8371 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8372 that can never match a client host.
8375 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8376 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8377 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8378 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8380 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8384 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8385 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8386 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8387 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8388 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8389 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8390 significant end of the address.
8392 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8393 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8394 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8395 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8399 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8400 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8403 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8405 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8406 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8408 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8409 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8412 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8414 could make use of a file containing
8419 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8420 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8421 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8423 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8426 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8432 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8433 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8434 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8435 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8436 address, the pattern takes this form:
8438 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8442 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8444 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8445 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8446 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8447 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8448 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8449 returned by the lookup is not used.
8451 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8452 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8453 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8454 patterns of this form:
8456 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8460 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8462 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8463 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8464 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8465 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8466 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8468 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8469 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8470 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8471 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8472 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8473 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8474 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8475 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8476 addresses are always used.
8478 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8479 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8480 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8483 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8484 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8485 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8486 case the IP address is used on its own.
8490 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8491 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8492 .cindex "unknown host name"
8493 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8494 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8495 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8496 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8497 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8500 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8501 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8502 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8503 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8504 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8505 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8506 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8508 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8509 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8511 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8512 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8513 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8514 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8515 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8516 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8517 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8518 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8519 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8521 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8522 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8524 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8525 .cindex "alias for host"
8526 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8527 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8530 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8531 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8532 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8533 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8534 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8537 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8538 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8539 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8540 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8541 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8542 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8543 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8548 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8549 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8550 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8551 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8552 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8554 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8556 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8557 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8558 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8565 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8566 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8567 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8568 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8569 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8570 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8572 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8573 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8575 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8576 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8577 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8578 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8579 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8580 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8581 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8582 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8583 not recognized in an indirected file).
8586 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8587 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8589 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8591 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8592 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8595 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8596 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8599 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8602 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8603 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8604 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8607 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8608 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8611 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8613 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8615 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8616 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8617 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8620 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8621 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8622 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8624 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8626 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8627 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8628 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8629 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8630 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8631 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8632 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8635 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8636 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8638 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8639 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8641 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8642 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8643 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8648 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8650 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8651 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8652 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8653 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8654 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8655 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8656 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8657 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8658 host lists such as whitelists.
8662 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8663 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8664 .cindex "unknown host name"
8665 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8666 If a pattern is of the form
8668 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8672 dbm;/host/accept/list
8674 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8675 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8678 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8679 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8680 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8681 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8682 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8683 lookup, both using the same file.
8687 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8688 If a pattern is of the form
8690 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8692 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8693 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8694 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8696 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8697 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8699 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8700 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8701 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8704 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8705 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8706 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8708 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8709 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8710 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8711 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8712 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8713 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8719 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8720 .cindex "list" "address list"
8721 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8722 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8723 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8724 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8725 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8726 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8727 using this option setting:
8731 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8732 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8733 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8734 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8736 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8739 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8741 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8742 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8743 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8744 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8745 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8746 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8747 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8749 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8750 *@+hostile_domains:\
8751 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8752 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8754 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8755 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8756 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8757 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8758 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8760 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8761 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8762 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8763 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8764 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8766 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8769 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8770 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8774 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8775 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8776 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8777 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8778 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8779 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8780 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8782 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8783 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8785 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8786 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8789 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8790 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8791 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8794 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8795 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8796 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8798 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8799 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8800 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8801 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8803 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8804 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8806 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8807 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8808 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8809 default. For example, with this lookup:
8811 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8813 the file could contains lines like this:
8815 user1@domain1.example
8818 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8821 nimrod@jaeger.example
8825 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8826 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8828 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8830 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8831 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8833 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8834 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8835 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8839 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8840 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8845 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8846 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8847 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8848 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8849 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8850 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8851 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8852 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8853 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8855 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8856 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8857 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8858 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8859 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8862 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8864 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8866 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8868 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8870 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8871 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8872 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8873 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8874 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8875 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8877 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8880 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8883 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8884 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8885 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8886 might have entries like
8888 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8889 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8892 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8893 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8894 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8895 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8897 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8898 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8899 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8902 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8903 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8904 can only return a single list of local parts.
8907 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8908 in these two examples:
8911 senders = *@+my_list
8913 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8914 example it is a named domain list.
8919 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8920 .cindex "case of local parts"
8921 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8922 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8923 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8924 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8925 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8926 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8927 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8928 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8931 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8932 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8933 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8934 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8935 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8936 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8937 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8940 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8941 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8942 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8943 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8944 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8945 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8946 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8947 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8951 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8952 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8953 .cindex "local part" "list"
8954 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8955 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8956 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8957 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8958 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8959 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8960 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8961 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8963 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8964 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8965 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8966 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8967 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8968 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8969 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8971 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8976 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8977 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8979 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8980 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8981 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8982 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8984 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8985 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8986 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8987 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8988 escape character, as described in the following section.
8990 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8991 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8992 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
8993 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8994 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8999 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9000 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9001 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9002 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9003 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9004 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9005 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9006 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9008 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9009 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9010 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9011 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9013 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9015 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9016 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9021 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9022 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9023 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9024 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9025 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9026 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9027 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9030 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9031 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9032 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9035 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9036 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9037 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9039 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9040 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9041 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9042 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9043 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9044 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9045 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9048 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9049 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9050 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9053 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9054 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9055 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9056 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9058 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9060 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9061 Exim message identifier. For example:
9063 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9065 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9066 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9069 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9070 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9071 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9072 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9073 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9074 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9075 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9076 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9077 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9078 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9079 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9080 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9086 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9087 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9088 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9089 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9090 white space is significant.
9093 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9094 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9095 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9100 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9101 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9102 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9103 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9104 given, the expansion fails.
9106 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9107 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9108 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9109 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9113 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9114 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9115 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9116 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9117 string easier to understand.
9119 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9120 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9121 expansion item below.
9124 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9125 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9126 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9127 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9128 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9129 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9130 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9131 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9132 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9133 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9134 the result of the expansion.
9135 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9136 the expansion result is an empty string.
9137 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9141 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9142 .cindex authentication "results header"
9143 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9144 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9145 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9147 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9148 will ba a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9149 Methods that may be present in the result include:
9158 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9160 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9165 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9166 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9167 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9168 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9169 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9170 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9171 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9172 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9176 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9177 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9182 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9186 If the field is found,
9187 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9188 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9189 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9190 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9192 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9193 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9196 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9198 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9199 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9201 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9202 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9203 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9204 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9205 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9206 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9207 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9208 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9210 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9211 take an optional modifier of "int"
9212 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9213 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9214 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9216 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9217 newline-separated by default,
9218 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9219 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9220 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9222 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9223 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9224 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9225 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9226 if so the element tags are omitted.
9228 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9230 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9231 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9233 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9234 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9238 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9239 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9240 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9242 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9243 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9244 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9245 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9246 must have the following type:
9248 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9250 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9251 function should return one of the following values:
9253 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9254 into the expanded string that is being built.
9256 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9257 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9259 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9260 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9262 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9264 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9265 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9266 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9269 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9270 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9271 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9272 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9274 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9275 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9276 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9278 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9279 appear, for example:
9281 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9283 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9284 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9286 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9288 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9291 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9292 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9295 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9296 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9297 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9298 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9299 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9300 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9301 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9302 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9304 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9307 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9308 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9309 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9310 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9311 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9312 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9313 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9314 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9315 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9317 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9318 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9319 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9322 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9323 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9325 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9326 appear, for example:
9328 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9330 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9331 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9334 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9335 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9336 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9337 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9338 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9339 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9340 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9341 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9342 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9343 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9344 <&'string3'&> as before.
9346 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9347 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9348 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9349 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9350 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9351 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9352 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9353 provided. For example:
9355 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9359 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9361 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9362 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9365 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9366 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9367 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9369 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9370 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9371 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9372 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9373 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9374 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9375 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9377 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9379 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9380 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9383 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9384 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9385 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9386 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9387 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9388 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9390 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9391 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9392 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9393 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9395 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9397 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9398 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9399 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9400 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9401 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9403 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9405 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9406 letters appear. For example:
9408 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9409 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9410 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9413 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9414 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9415 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9416 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9417 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9418 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9419 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9420 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9421 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9422 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9423 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9424 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9425 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9426 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9430 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9431 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9432 lines) may be present.
9434 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9435 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9438 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9439 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9440 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9443 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9444 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9445 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9446 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9447 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9448 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9449 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9450 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9453 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9454 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9455 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9456 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9457 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9458 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9461 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9462 command of the following form:
9464 headers charset "UTF-8"
9466 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9467 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9468 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9469 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9470 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9473 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9474 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9475 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9476 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9478 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9479 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9480 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9481 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9482 router or transport are not accessible.
9484 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9485 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9486 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9487 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9488 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9489 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9490 point they are added.
9491 When any of the above ACLs ar
9492 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9494 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9495 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9496 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9497 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9498 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9499 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9500 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9503 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9504 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9505 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9506 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9507 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9508 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9509 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9510 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9513 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9514 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9516 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9517 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9518 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9519 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9520 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9521 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9522 present. For example:
9524 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9526 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9529 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9531 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9532 an Exim configuration:
9534 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9536 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9539 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9540 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9541 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9543 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9544 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9545 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9546 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9547 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9548 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9551 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9552 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9553 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9554 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9555 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9556 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9558 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9560 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9561 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9562 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9563 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9564 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9566 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9567 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9568 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9570 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9574 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9579 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9580 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9581 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9582 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9583 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9584 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9588 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9589 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9590 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9591 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9592 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9593 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9594 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9597 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9599 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9600 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9601 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9604 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9605 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9606 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9607 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9608 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9609 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9610 apart from an optional leading minus,
9611 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9613 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9614 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9616 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9617 If the number is negative, the fields are
9618 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9619 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9620 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9622 If the modulus of the
9623 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9624 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9628 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9632 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9634 yields &"result: 42"&.
9636 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9637 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9639 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9642 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9643 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9644 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9645 described in the next item.
9647 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9648 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9649 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9650 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9651 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9652 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9653 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9654 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9655 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9657 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9658 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9659 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9660 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9661 out by the system administrator.
9664 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9665 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9666 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9667 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9668 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9669 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9670 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9671 original lookup fails.
9673 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9674 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9675 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9676 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9677 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9678 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9679 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9680 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9682 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9683 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9684 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9685 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9687 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9688 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9689 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9690 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9692 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9694 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9696 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9697 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9699 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9704 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9705 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9707 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9708 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9709 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9710 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9711 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9712 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9714 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9716 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9717 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9718 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9720 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9721 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9722 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9723 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9724 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9725 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9726 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9728 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9730 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9731 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9732 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9733 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9736 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9738 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9742 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9743 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9744 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9745 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9746 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9747 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9748 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9749 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9751 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9752 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9753 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9754 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9755 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9758 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9759 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9760 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9762 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9763 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9766 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9767 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9768 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9769 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9770 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9771 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9772 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9773 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9775 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9776 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9777 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9778 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9779 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9780 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9781 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9782 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9783 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9784 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9786 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9787 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9788 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9789 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9791 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9792 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9793 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9794 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9795 is the expansion of the third argument.
9797 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9798 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9799 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9801 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9802 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9803 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9804 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9805 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9806 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9807 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9808 newlines are left in the string.
9809 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9810 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9811 the string expansion fails.
9813 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9814 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9818 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9819 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9820 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9821 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9822 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9823 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9824 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9827 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9828 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9830 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9831 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9832 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9833 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9834 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9837 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9839 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9840 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9841 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9842 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9843 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9844 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9845 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9847 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9849 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9850 and must be present if the argument is given.
9851 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9852 One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9853 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9854 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9856 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9858 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9859 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9860 turns them into spaces:
9862 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9864 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9865 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9866 addition, the following errors can occur:
9869 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9871 Failure to connect the socket;
9873 Failure to write the request string;
9875 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9878 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9879 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9880 errors occurs. For example:
9882 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9885 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9886 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9887 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9888 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9889 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9891 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9892 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9895 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9896 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9897 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9900 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9901 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9902 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9903 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9904 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9905 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9906 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9907 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9908 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9910 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9912 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9915 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9917 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9918 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9921 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9922 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9923 expansion item above.
9925 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9926 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9927 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9928 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9929 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9930 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9931 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9932 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9933 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9935 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9936 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9937 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9938 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9939 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9940 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9941 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9942 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9943 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9946 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9947 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9948 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9950 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9951 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9952 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9953 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9954 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9957 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9958 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9959 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9960 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9962 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9963 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9964 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9967 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9968 log_message = Output of id: $value
9970 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9971 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9973 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9977 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9978 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9980 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9981 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9985 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9986 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9989 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9990 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9991 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9992 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9994 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9995 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9998 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9999 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10000 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10001 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10002 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10003 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10004 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10005 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10007 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10009 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10010 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10011 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10013 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10015 yields &"defabc"&, and
10017 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10019 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10020 the regular expression from string expansion.
10024 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10025 .cindex sorting "a list"
10026 .cindex list sorting
10027 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10028 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10029 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
10030 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10031 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10032 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10033 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10034 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10035 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10036 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10037 to give values for comparison.
10039 The item result is a sorted list,
10040 with the original list separator,
10041 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10045 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10047 sorts a list of numbers, and
10049 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10051 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10054 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10055 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10056 .cindex "substring extraction"
10057 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10058 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10059 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10060 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10061 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10063 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10065 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10066 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10069 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10070 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10071 length required. For example
10073 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10075 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10076 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10077 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10078 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10080 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10081 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10082 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10084 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10086 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10087 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10088 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10090 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10092 yields an empty string, but
10094 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10098 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10099 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10100 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10101 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10104 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10106 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10110 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10111 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10112 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10113 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10114 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10115 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10116 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10117 replacement list. For example
10119 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10121 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10122 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10123 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10129 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10130 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10131 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10132 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10133 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10134 following operations can be performed:
10137 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10138 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10139 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10140 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10141 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10142 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10145 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10146 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10147 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10148 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10149 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10150 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10151 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10152 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10153 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10155 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10156 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10157 character. For example:
10159 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10161 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10162 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10163 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10164 separator explicitly:
10166 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10169 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10170 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10171 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10174 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10175 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10176 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10177 email address separator. For the example header line:
10179 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10181 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10182 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10183 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10184 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10185 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10186 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10189 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10190 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10192 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10193 Last:user@example.com
10194 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10198 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10199 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10200 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10201 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10202 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10203 Only lowercase letters are used.
10205 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10206 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10207 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10208 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10209 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10211 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10212 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10213 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10214 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10215 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10216 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10217 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10218 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10219 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10221 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10222 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10223 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10224 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10225 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10226 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10229 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10230 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10231 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10232 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10233 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10234 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10236 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10237 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10240 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10241 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10242 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10243 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10244 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10247 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10248 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10249 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10250 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10251 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10254 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10255 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10256 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10257 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10258 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10259 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10260 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10262 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10263 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10264 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10265 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10266 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10267 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10270 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10271 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10272 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10273 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10274 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10275 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10276 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10277 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10278 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10279 C programming language):
10281 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10282 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10283 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10284 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10285 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10287 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10289 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10290 space is permitted before or after operators.
10292 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10293 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10294 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10295 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10296 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10298 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10300 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10301 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10304 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10305 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10306 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10307 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10308 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10309 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10310 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10311 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10312 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10313 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10314 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10317 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10319 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10322 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10325 {$recipients_count} \
10326 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10330 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10331 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10334 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10335 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10336 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10339 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10341 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10342 and then re-expands what it has found.
10345 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10347 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10348 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10349 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10350 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10351 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10352 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10353 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10354 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10355 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10357 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10358 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10359 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10360 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10361 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10362 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10363 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10366 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10367 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10368 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10369 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10370 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10371 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10373 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10375 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10376 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10380 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10381 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10382 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10383 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10384 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10385 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10389 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10390 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10391 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10392 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10393 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10394 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10395 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10398 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10399 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10400 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10401 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10402 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10403 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10404 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10406 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10407 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10408 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10409 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10410 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10411 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10412 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10413 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10414 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10417 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10418 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10419 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10420 .cindex "lower casing"
10421 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10422 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10423 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10428 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10429 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10430 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10431 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10432 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10433 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10435 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10437 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10438 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10439 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10442 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10443 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10444 .cindex "list" "item count"
10445 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10446 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10447 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10450 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10451 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10452 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10453 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10454 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10455 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10456 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10457 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10458 matching list is returned.
10461 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10462 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10463 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10464 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10465 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10469 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10470 .cindex "masked IP address"
10471 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10472 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10473 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10474 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10475 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10476 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10477 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10478 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10479 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10481 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10483 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10484 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10485 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10486 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10488 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10492 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10494 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10497 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10499 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10500 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10501 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10502 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10503 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10505 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10506 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10509 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10510 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10511 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10512 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10513 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10514 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10516 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10518 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10521 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10522 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10523 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10524 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10525 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10526 is an empty string or
10527 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10528 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10529 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10530 respectively For example,
10538 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10539 variable or a message header.
10541 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10542 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10543 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10544 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10545 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10546 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10547 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10550 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10551 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10552 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10553 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10554 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10556 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10562 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10563 yields an unchanged string.
10566 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10567 .cindex "random number"
10568 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10569 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10570 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10571 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10572 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10573 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10574 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10575 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10579 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10580 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10581 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10582 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10583 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10584 for DNS. For example,
10586 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10587 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10592 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10596 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10597 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10598 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10599 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10600 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10601 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10602 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10603 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10604 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10607 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10609 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10610 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10614 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10615 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10616 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10617 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10618 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10619 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10620 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10621 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10623 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10624 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10625 to use this operator as well.
10629 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10630 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10631 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10632 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10633 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10634 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10635 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10638 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10639 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10640 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10641 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10642 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10643 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10644 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10646 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10647 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10650 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10651 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10652 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10653 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10654 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10655 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10657 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10659 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10660 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10663 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10664 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10665 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10666 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10667 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10668 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10670 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10672 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10673 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10674 with 256 being the default.
10676 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10677 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10679 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10680 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10684 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10685 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10686 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10687 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10688 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10689 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10690 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10691 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10692 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10693 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10694 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10695 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10696 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10698 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10699 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10700 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10702 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10703 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10704 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10708 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10709 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10710 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10711 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10712 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10713 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10716 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10717 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10718 .cindex "substring extraction"
10719 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10720 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10721 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10722 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10724 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10726 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10727 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10729 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10730 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10731 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10732 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10735 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10736 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10737 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10738 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10739 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10740 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10743 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10744 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10745 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10746 .cindex "upper casing"
10747 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10748 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10749 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10751 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10752 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10753 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10754 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10755 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10756 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10757 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10759 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10760 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10761 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10762 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10763 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10764 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10766 .cindex internationalisation
10767 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10768 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10769 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10770 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10771 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10772 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10780 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10781 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10782 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10783 while expanding strings:
10786 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10787 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10788 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10789 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10792 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10793 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10794 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10795 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10801 &`>= `& greater or equal
10803 &`<= `& less or equal
10807 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10809 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10810 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10811 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10812 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10813 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10816 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10817 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10818 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10821 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10822 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10823 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10824 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10825 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10826 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10827 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10828 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10829 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10830 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10831 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10832 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10833 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10834 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10836 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10837 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10838 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10839 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10840 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10841 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10843 An empty string is treated as false.
10844 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10845 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10846 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10848 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10849 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10852 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10856 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10857 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10858 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10859 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10860 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10861 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10862 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10863 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10865 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10867 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10868 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10869 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10870 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10871 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10872 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10873 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10874 included in the binary.
10876 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10877 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10878 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10879 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10880 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10881 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10882 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10883 string in LDAP form is:
10885 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10887 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10888 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10890 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10892 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10897 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10898 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10899 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10900 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10901 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10902 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10906 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10907 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10908 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10909 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10910 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10911 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10914 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10915 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10916 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10917 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10918 whatever its length.
10921 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10922 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10923 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10924 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10926 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10927 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10928 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10929 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10930 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10931 support &[crypt16()]&.
10933 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10934 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10935 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10936 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10937 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10939 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10940 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10941 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10943 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10944 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10945 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10946 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10947 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10949 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10950 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10951 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10952 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10953 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10954 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10956 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10958 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10959 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10961 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10962 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10963 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10964 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10965 exists in the message. For example,
10967 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10969 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10970 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10972 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10973 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10974 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10975 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10976 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10977 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10978 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10979 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10980 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10982 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10983 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10984 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10985 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10986 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10987 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10988 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10989 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10991 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10992 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10993 .cindex "first delivery"
10994 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10995 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10996 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10997 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11000 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11001 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11002 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11003 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11004 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11006 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11007 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11008 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11009 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11010 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11012 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11013 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11014 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11016 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11017 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11018 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11020 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11021 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11022 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11023 list separator is changed to a comma:
11025 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11027 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11028 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11030 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11033 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11034 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11035 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11036 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11037 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11038 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11039 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11040 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11041 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11044 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11045 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11046 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11047 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11048 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11049 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11050 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11051 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11052 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11055 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11056 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11057 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11058 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11059 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11060 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11063 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11064 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11066 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11067 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11068 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11069 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11072 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11073 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11074 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11075 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11076 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11077 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11078 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11079 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11080 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11081 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11082 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11084 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11085 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11086 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11087 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11088 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11090 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11091 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11093 This is no longer the case.
11095 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11096 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11098 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11100 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11102 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11103 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11104 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11105 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11106 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11107 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11108 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11109 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11110 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11111 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11112 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11113 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11114 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11118 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11119 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11120 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11121 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11122 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11123 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11124 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11125 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11126 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11129 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11130 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11131 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11132 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11133 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11134 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11135 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11136 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11137 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11141 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11142 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11143 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11144 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11145 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11146 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11147 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11148 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11149 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11150 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11151 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11154 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11156 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11157 backslashes is also required.
11159 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11160 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11161 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11162 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11163 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11164 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11166 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11167 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11168 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11169 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11170 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11171 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11172 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11173 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11175 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11176 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11177 See &*match_local_part*&.
11179 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11180 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11181 See &*match_local_part*&.
11183 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11184 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11185 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11186 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11187 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11188 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11190 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11192 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11195 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11197 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11199 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11200 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11201 in a single test such as
11202 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11203 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11204 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11205 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11207 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11209 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11211 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11213 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11214 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11215 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11216 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11217 masks. For example:
11219 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11221 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11222 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11223 address mask, for example:
11225 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11227 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11228 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11230 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11234 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11235 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11237 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11239 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11240 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11241 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11242 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11243 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11244 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11245 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11246 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11249 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11251 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11252 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11253 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11254 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11256 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11258 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11259 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11260 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11261 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11264 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11265 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11267 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11268 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11269 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11270 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11272 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11273 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11274 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11275 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11276 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11277 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11278 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11279 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11280 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11281 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11282 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11286 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11287 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11289 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11290 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11291 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11292 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11293 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11294 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11295 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11297 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11298 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11299 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11300 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11301 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11303 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11305 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11307 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11309 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11310 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11311 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11312 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11313 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11314 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11315 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11316 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11319 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11320 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11322 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11323 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11324 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11325 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11326 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11327 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11329 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11330 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11331 building Exim. For example:
11333 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11335 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11336 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11337 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11338 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11340 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11341 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11342 configuration, you might have this:
11344 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11346 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11348 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11350 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11351 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11352 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11353 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11354 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11355 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11358 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11360 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11361 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11362 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11363 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11364 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11367 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11368 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11369 this library, you need to set
11371 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11373 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11374 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11376 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11378 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11379 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11380 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11382 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11383 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11384 the authentication is successful. For example:
11386 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11390 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11391 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11392 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11394 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11395 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11396 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11397 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11398 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11399 by a process that is not running as root.
11401 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11402 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11403 building Exim. For example:
11405 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11407 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11408 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11409 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11411 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11412 two are mandatory. For example:
11414 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11416 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11417 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11418 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11423 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11424 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11425 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11426 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11427 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11428 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11429 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11433 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11434 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11435 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11436 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11437 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11440 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11442 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11443 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11444 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11446 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11447 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11448 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11449 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11450 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11451 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11452 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11453 parsed but not evaluated.
11455 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11460 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11461 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11462 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11463 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11464 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11467 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11468 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11469 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11470 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11471 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11472 In the expansion condition case
11473 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11474 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11475 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11476 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11477 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11478 matching condition.
11480 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11481 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11482 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11483 any unused variables being made empty.
11485 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11486 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11487 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11488 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11489 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11490 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11491 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11492 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11493 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11494 during subsequent delivery.
11496 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11497 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11498 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11499 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11500 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11501 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11502 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11503 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11506 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11507 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11508 this variable has the number of arguments.
11510 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11511 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11512 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11513 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11514 be preserved by coding like this:
11516 warn !verify = sender
11517 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11519 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11520 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11523 .vitem &$address_data$&
11524 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11525 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11526 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11527 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11528 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11529 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11532 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11533 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11534 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11535 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11536 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11537 from the child's routing.
11539 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11540 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11541 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11544 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11545 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11546 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11548 .vitem &$address_file$&
11549 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11550 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11551 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11552 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11553 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11555 /home/r2d2/savemail
11557 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11558 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11559 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11560 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11561 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11562 to the relevant file.
11564 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11565 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11566 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11567 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11569 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11570 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11571 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11572 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11574 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11575 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11576 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11577 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11578 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11579 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11580 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11581 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11582 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11583 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11584 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11585 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11586 command line option.
11588 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11589 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11590 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11591 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11592 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11593 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11594 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11595 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11596 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11600 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11601 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11602 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11603 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11604 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11605 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11606 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11607 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11608 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11609 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11610 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11612 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11613 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11614 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11615 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11616 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11619 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11620 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11621 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11622 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11623 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11624 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11625 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11626 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11627 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11628 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11629 an undefined mechanism.
11631 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11632 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11633 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11634 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11635 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11636 the ACL malware condition.
11638 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11639 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11640 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11641 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11642 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11643 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11645 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11646 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11647 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11648 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11649 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11650 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11651 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11653 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11654 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11655 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11656 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11657 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11659 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11660 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11661 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11662 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11663 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11665 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11666 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11667 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11668 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11669 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11670 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11671 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11673 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11674 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11675 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11676 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11677 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11678 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11679 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11681 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11682 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11683 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11684 address that was connected to.
11686 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11687 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11688 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11689 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11690 compilations of the same version of the program.
11692 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11693 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11694 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11695 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11696 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11697 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11699 .vitem &$config_file$&
11700 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11701 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11703 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
11704 Results of DKIM verification.
11705 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11707 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11708 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11709 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11710 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11711 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11713 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11714 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11715 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11716 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11717 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11718 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11719 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11720 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11721 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11722 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11723 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11724 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11725 &$dkim_key_length$&
11726 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11727 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11729 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11730 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11731 When a message has been received this variable contains
11732 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11733 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11735 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11736 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11737 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11739 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11740 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11741 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11742 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11743 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11744 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11745 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11746 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11747 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11750 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11751 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11752 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11753 case for &$domain$&.
11755 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11756 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11757 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11758 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11760 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11761 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11762 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11763 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11764 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11765 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11767 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11768 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11769 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11771 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11774 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11775 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11776 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11777 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11778 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11779 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11780 the &(smtp)& transport.
11783 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11784 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11785 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11786 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11789 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11790 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11791 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11792 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11793 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11794 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11797 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11798 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11799 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11800 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11804 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11805 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11806 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11807 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11808 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11809 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11810 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11813 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11814 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11815 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11818 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11819 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11820 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11822 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11823 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11824 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11826 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11827 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11828 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11830 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11831 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11832 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11833 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11834 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11835 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11837 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11838 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11839 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11840 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11841 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11843 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11844 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11845 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11846 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11847 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11851 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11852 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11853 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11854 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11855 by a setting on the transport itself.
11857 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11858 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11859 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11863 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11864 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11865 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11866 to local and remote transports.
11868 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11869 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11870 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11871 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11872 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11873 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11874 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11877 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11878 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11879 client is connected.
11882 .vitem &$host_address$&
11883 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11884 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11885 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11886 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11888 .vitem &$host_data$&
11889 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11890 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11891 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11892 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11894 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11895 message = $host_data
11897 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11898 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11899 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11900 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11901 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11902 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11903 variables is set to &"1"&.
11906 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11907 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11910 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11911 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11912 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11915 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11916 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11917 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11918 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11919 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11920 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11921 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11922 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11923 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11924 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11926 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11927 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11928 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11930 .vitem &$host_port$&
11931 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11932 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11933 for an outbound connection.
11935 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11936 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11937 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11938 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11939 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11940 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11943 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11944 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11945 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11946 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11947 a unique name for the file.
11949 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11950 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11951 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11953 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11954 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11955 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11959 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11960 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11961 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11965 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11966 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11967 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11970 .vitem &$load_average$&
11971 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11972 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11973 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11974 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11976 .vitem &$local_part$&
11977 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11978 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11979 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11980 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11981 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11983 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11984 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11985 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11986 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11989 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11990 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11991 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11992 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11993 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11994 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11996 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11997 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11998 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
12001 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12002 local part of the recipient address.
12004 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12005 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12006 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12008 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12011 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12012 abc\:xyz@test.example
12014 the value of &$local_part$& is
12018 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12019 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12022 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12024 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12025 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12026 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12028 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12029 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12030 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12031 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12032 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12033 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12034 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12036 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12037 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12038 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12039 variable expands to nothing.
12041 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12042 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12043 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12044 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12045 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12047 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12048 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12049 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12050 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12051 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12053 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12054 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12055 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12056 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12058 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12059 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12060 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12062 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12063 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12064 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12065 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12066 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12067 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12068 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12069 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12071 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12072 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12073 This contains the expanded value of the
12074 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12077 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12078 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12079 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12080 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12081 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12082 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12084 .vitem &$log_space$&
12085 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12086 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12087 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12088 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12089 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12090 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12093 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12094 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12095 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12096 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12097 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12098 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12099 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12100 and &"yes"& if it was.
12101 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12102 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12103 as authenticated data.
12105 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12106 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12107 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12108 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12109 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12110 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12111 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12114 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12115 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12116 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12117 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12118 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12120 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12121 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12122 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12123 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12124 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12125 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12127 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12129 .vitem &$message_age$&
12130 .cindex "message" "age of"
12131 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12132 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12133 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12136 .vitem &$message_body$&
12137 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12138 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12139 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12140 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12141 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12142 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12143 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12144 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12145 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12147 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12148 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12149 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12150 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12151 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12153 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12154 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12155 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12156 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12157 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12158 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12161 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12162 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12163 .cindex "message body" "size"
12164 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12165 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12166 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12167 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12168 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12170 If the spool file is wireformat
12171 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12172 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12174 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12175 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12176 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12177 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12178 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12179 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12180 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12181 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12183 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12184 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12185 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12186 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12187 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12188 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12190 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12191 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12192 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12193 contents of header lines is done.
12195 .vitem &$message_id$&
12196 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12198 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12199 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12200 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12201 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12202 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12203 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12204 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12205 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12206 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12207 from the body is not counted.
12209 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12210 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12211 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12212 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12213 header and the body).
12215 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12217 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12219 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12221 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12222 message has not yet been received.
12224 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12226 .vitem &$message_size$&
12227 .cindex "size" "of message"
12228 .cindex "message" "size"
12229 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12230 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12231 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12232 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12233 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12234 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12235 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12236 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12237 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12239 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12240 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12241 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12242 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12244 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12245 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12246 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12247 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12249 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12250 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12251 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12253 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12254 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12255 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12256 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12257 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12258 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12259 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12260 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12261 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12262 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12264 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12265 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12266 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12268 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12269 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12270 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12271 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12272 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12273 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12274 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12275 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12276 the original address.
12278 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12279 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12280 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12281 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12282 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12284 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12285 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12286 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12288 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12289 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12290 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12291 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12292 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12293 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12294 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12295 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12296 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12298 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12299 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12300 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12301 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12302 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12303 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12304 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12305 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12308 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12309 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12310 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12311 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12313 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12314 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12315 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12316 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12319 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12321 This variable contains the current process id.
12323 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12324 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12325 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12326 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12327 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12328 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12329 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12330 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12331 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12332 variable"& error if encountered.
12334 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12335 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12336 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12337 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12338 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12339 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12340 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12343 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12344 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12345 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12346 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12348 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12350 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12352 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12353 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12354 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12355 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12357 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12358 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12359 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12360 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12362 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12363 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12364 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12365 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12367 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12368 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12369 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12370 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12372 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12373 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12374 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12376 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12377 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12378 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12379 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12381 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12382 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12383 .cindex "named queues"
12384 .cindex queues named
12385 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12387 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12388 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12389 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12390 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12391 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12393 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12394 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12395 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12396 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12397 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12398 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12400 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12401 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12402 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12403 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12404 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12406 .vitem &$received_count$&
12407 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12408 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12409 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12410 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12413 .vitem &$received_for$&
12414 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12415 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12416 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12417 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12418 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12420 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12421 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12422 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12423 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12424 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12425 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12426 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12429 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12430 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12431 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12432 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12433 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12435 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12437 .vitem &$received_port$&
12438 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12439 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12441 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12442 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12443 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12444 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12445 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12446 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12447 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12448 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12449 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12451 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12452 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12453 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12454 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12455 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12456 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12458 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12459 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12460 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12462 .vitem &$received_time$&
12463 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12464 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12465 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12467 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12468 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12469 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12470 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12471 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12473 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12474 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12476 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12477 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12478 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12479 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12481 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12482 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12483 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12484 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12487 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12488 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12491 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12494 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12495 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12499 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12502 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12505 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12506 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12508 .vitem &$recipients$&
12509 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12510 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12511 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12512 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12513 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12517 In a system filter file.
12519 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12520 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12521 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12522 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12524 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12528 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12529 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12530 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12531 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12532 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12533 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12536 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12537 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12538 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12539 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12541 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12542 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12543 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12544 these variables contain the
12545 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12548 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12549 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12550 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12551 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12552 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12553 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12554 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12556 .vitem &$return_path$&
12557 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12558 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12559 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12560 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12561 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12562 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12563 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12564 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12565 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12566 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12569 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12570 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12571 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12573 .vitem &$router_name$&
12574 .cindex "router" "name"
12575 .cindex "name" "of router"
12576 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12577 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12580 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12581 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12582 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12583 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12584 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12585 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12586 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12589 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12590 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12591 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12592 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12593 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12594 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12595 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12596 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12598 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12599 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12600 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12601 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12602 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12603 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12605 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12606 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12607 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12608 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12609 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12610 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12611 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12612 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12614 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12615 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12616 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12618 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12619 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12620 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12622 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12623 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12624 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12625 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12626 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12629 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12630 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12632 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12633 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12634 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12635 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12637 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12638 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12639 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12640 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12641 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12642 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12643 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12644 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12645 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12646 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12647 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12648 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12649 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12651 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12652 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12653 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12654 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12655 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12657 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12658 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12659 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12660 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12661 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12662 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12664 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12665 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12666 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12667 this variable contains that
12668 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12670 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12671 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12672 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12673 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12674 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12675 &$authenticated_id$&.
12677 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12678 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12679 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12680 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12681 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12682 resolver library states that both
12683 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12684 other times, this variable is false.
12686 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12687 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12688 library, by setting:
12693 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12694 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12696 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12697 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12699 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12700 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12701 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12702 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12705 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12706 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12707 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12708 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12709 other means, this variable is empty.
12711 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12712 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12713 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12714 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12715 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12716 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12717 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12719 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12720 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12721 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12722 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12724 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12725 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12726 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12729 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12730 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12731 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12732 following are true:
12735 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12737 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12738 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12739 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12741 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12742 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12743 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12745 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12746 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12747 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12749 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12750 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12751 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12752 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12754 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12756 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12757 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12761 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12762 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12763 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12764 number that was used on the remote host.
12766 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12767 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12768 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12769 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12770 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12773 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12774 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12775 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12776 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12778 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12779 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12780 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12781 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12782 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12783 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12784 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12785 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12786 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12787 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12788 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12791 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12792 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12793 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12794 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12795 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12797 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12798 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12799 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12800 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12801 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12803 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12804 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12805 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12806 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12807 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12808 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12809 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12811 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12812 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12813 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12814 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12815 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12817 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12818 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12819 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12820 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12821 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12822 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12824 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12825 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12826 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12827 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12828 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12833 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12834 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12835 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12836 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12838 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12839 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12840 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12841 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12842 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12843 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12844 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12846 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12847 .cindex SMTP "command history"
12848 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12849 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12850 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12853 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12854 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12855 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12856 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12857 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12858 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12859 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12860 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12861 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12862 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12863 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12865 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12866 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12867 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12868 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12869 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12870 message is junk mail.
12872 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12873 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12874 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12875 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12878 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
12879 &$spf_received$& &&&
12881 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
12882 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
12883 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
12886 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12887 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12888 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12890 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12891 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12892 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12893 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12894 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12895 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12897 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12898 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12899 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12900 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12901 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12902 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12903 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12904 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12906 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12908 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12911 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12912 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12913 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12914 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12915 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12916 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12918 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12919 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12920 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12921 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12922 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12923 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12924 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12925 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12927 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12928 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12931 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12932 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12933 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12934 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12935 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12936 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12938 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12939 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12940 .cindex certificate variables
12941 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12942 inbound connection when the message was received.
12943 It is only useful as the argument of a
12944 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12945 or a &%def%& condition.
12947 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
12948 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
12950 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12951 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12952 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12953 inbound connection when the message was received.
12954 It is only useful as the argument of a
12955 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12956 or a &%def%& condition.
12957 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12958 which is not the leaf.
12960 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12961 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12962 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12963 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12964 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12965 or a &%def%& condition.
12967 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12968 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12969 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12970 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12971 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12972 or a &%def%& condition.
12973 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12974 which is not the leaf.
12976 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12977 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12978 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12979 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12981 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12982 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12985 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12986 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12987 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12988 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12989 and &"0"& otherwise.
12991 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12992 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12993 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12994 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12995 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12996 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12997 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12998 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12999 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13001 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13002 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13003 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13005 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13006 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13008 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13009 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13010 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13011 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13013 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13014 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13015 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13017 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13018 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13019 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13020 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13022 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13023 1 No response to request
13024 2 Response not verified
13025 3 Verification failed
13026 4 Verification succeeded
13029 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13030 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13031 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13032 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13033 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13035 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13036 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13037 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13038 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13039 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13040 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13041 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13042 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13043 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13044 which is not the leaf.
13046 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13047 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13050 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13051 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13052 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13053 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13054 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13055 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13056 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13057 which is not the leaf.
13059 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13060 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13061 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13062 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13063 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13064 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13065 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13066 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13067 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13068 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13069 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13071 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13072 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13075 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13076 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13077 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13079 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13082 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13083 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13084 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13086 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13087 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13088 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13089 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13091 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13092 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13093 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13095 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13096 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13097 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13099 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13100 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13101 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13102 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13103 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13104 values for those that are behind (west).
13107 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13108 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13109 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13111 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13112 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13113 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13114 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13117 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13118 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13119 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13122 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13123 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13124 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13125 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13127 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13128 .cindex "transport" "name"
13129 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13130 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13131 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13134 .vindex "&$value$&"
13135 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13136 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13137 &*reduce*& expansion.
13139 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13140 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13141 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13142 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13145 .vitem &$version_number$&
13146 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13147 The version number of Exim.
13149 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13150 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13151 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13152 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13154 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13155 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13156 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13157 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13166 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13167 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13168 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13169 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13170 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13171 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13176 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13179 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13180 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13181 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13182 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13183 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13184 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13185 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13186 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13187 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13189 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13190 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13191 should usually be something like
13193 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13195 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13196 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13197 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13198 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13199 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13200 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13201 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13202 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13206 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13207 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13208 a startup when Exim is entered.
13210 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13211 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13214 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13215 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13218 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13219 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13220 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13221 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13222 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13223 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13227 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13228 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13229 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13230 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13234 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13235 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13237 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13238 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13239 with an error message of the form
13241 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13243 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13244 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13245 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13246 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13247 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13248 that was passed to &%die%&.
13251 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13252 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13253 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13256 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13258 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13259 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13260 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13262 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13263 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13264 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13265 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13267 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13268 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13269 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13270 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13271 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13272 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13273 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13276 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13277 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13278 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13279 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13280 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13281 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13282 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13283 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13284 avoided, but the output is lost.
13286 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13287 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13288 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13289 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13290 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13291 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13292 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13294 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13296 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13297 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13298 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13299 as the first subroutine argument.
13303 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13306 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13307 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13308 "Starting the daemon"
13309 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13310 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13311 .cindex "network interface"
13312 .cindex "interface" "network"
13313 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13314 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13315 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13316 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13317 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13318 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13319 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13320 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13321 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13322 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13323 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13326 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13327 and ports to listen on.
13329 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13330 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13331 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13332 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13333 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13334 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13335 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13336 as an error situation.
13338 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13339 for the outgoing connection.
13343 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13344 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13345 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13346 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13347 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13349 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13350 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13351 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13352 chapter describes how they operate.
13354 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13355 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13359 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13360 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13361 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13365 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13367 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13369 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13370 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13373 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13374 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13375 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13376 colons. For example:
13378 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13381 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13383 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13384 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13387 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13388 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13390 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13391 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13394 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13395 with a colon separator, for example:
13397 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13398 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13402 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13403 default setting contains just one port:
13405 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13407 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13408 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13409 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13410 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13411 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13415 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13416 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13417 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13418 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13419 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13420 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13422 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13424 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13426 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13428 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13432 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13433 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13434 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13435 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13436 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13437 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13440 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13441 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13442 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13443 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13444 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13445 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13449 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13452 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13454 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13455 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13456 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13460 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13461 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13462 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13463 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13464 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13465 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13466 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13467 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13468 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13469 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13470 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13471 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13472 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13475 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13476 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13477 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13479 The common use of this option is expected to be
13481 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13484 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13485 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13487 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13488 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13489 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13490 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13491 connections via the daemon.)
13496 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13497 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13498 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13499 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13500 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13501 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13502 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13503 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13505 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13507 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13508 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13509 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13510 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13511 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13512 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13514 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13516 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13517 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13518 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13519 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13520 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13522 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13523 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13524 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13525 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13526 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13527 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13528 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13529 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13530 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13531 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13532 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13533 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13535 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13536 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13537 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13538 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13539 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13543 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13544 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13546 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13547 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13549 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13550 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13551 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13552 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13554 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13556 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13558 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13560 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13561 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13563 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13564 IPv4 loopback address only:
13566 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13568 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13570 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13572 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13576 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13577 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13578 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13579 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13582 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13583 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13584 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13585 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13587 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13588 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13589 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13590 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13591 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13592 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13593 used for listening. Consider this example:
13595 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13597 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13599 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13601 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13602 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13605 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13606 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13607 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13608 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13609 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13610 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13611 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13612 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13616 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13617 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13618 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13619 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13620 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13621 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13627 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13630 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13631 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13632 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13633 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13636 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13637 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13639 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13640 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13641 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13643 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13644 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13645 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13646 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13650 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13651 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13652 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13653 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13654 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13655 listed in more than one group.
13657 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13659 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13660 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13661 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13662 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13663 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13664 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13665 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13666 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13667 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13668 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13669 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13673 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13675 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13676 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13677 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13678 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13679 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13680 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13685 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13687 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13688 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13689 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13690 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13691 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13692 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13693 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13694 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13695 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13696 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13697 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13698 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13703 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13705 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13706 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13707 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13708 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13709 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13710 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13711 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13712 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13713 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13714 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13715 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13716 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13717 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13718 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13719 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13724 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13726 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13727 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13728 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13729 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13734 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13736 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13737 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13738 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13739 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13740 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13741 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13742 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13743 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13744 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13745 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13746 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13747 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13748 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13749 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13750 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13755 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13757 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13758 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13763 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13765 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13766 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13767 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13772 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13774 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13775 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13776 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13777 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13778 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13779 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13780 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13785 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13787 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13788 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13789 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13790 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13791 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13792 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13793 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13794 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13795 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13796 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13797 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13798 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13799 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13800 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13801 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13802 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13804 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13805 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13806 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13807 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13808 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13813 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13815 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13816 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13817 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13818 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13819 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13820 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13821 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13822 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13823 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13824 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13825 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13826 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13827 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13828 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13829 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13830 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13831 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13832 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13833 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13834 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13835 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13836 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13838 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13839 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13840 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13841 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13842 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13843 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13844 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13845 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13846 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13847 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13848 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13849 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13850 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13851 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13852 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13853 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13854 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13855 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13856 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13861 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13863 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13865 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13867 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13868 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13869 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13874 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13876 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13877 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13878 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13879 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13880 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13881 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13882 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13883 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13884 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13885 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13886 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13887 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13888 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13889 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13890 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13891 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13892 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13897 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13899 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13900 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13901 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13902 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13903 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13904 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13905 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13906 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13911 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13913 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13914 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13915 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13916 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13917 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13918 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13919 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13920 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13926 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13928 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13935 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13936 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13939 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13940 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13941 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13942 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13943 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13944 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13945 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13946 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13947 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13948 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13949 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13950 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13951 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13952 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13953 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13955 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13956 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13957 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13958 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13959 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13960 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13961 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13962 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13963 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13964 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13965 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13966 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13967 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13968 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13969 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13970 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13975 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13977 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13978 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13979 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
13980 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13981 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13982 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13983 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13984 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13985 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
13986 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13991 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13993 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13994 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13995 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13996 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13998 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13999 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14000 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14001 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14002 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14003 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14004 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14005 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14006 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14007 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14012 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14014 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14015 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14017 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14018 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14019 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14020 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14021 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14026 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14028 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14029 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14030 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14031 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14032 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14033 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14034 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14035 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14036 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14037 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14038 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14039 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14040 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14041 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14042 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14043 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14044 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14045 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14046 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14047 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14048 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14049 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14050 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14051 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14056 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14058 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14059 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14060 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14061 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14062 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14063 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14064 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14065 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14066 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14067 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14068 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14069 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14070 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14071 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14072 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14077 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14078 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14081 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14083 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14084 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14085 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14086 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14087 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14088 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14089 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14091 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14092 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14093 It now defaults to true.
14094 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14096 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14099 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14101 log_selector = +8bitmime
14104 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14105 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14106 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14107 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14108 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14111 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14112 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14113 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14116 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14117 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14118 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14119 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14120 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14122 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14123 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14124 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14125 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14126 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14128 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14129 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14130 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14131 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14133 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14134 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14135 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14136 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14137 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14139 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14140 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14141 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14142 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14143 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14144 This option defines the ACL that,
14145 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14146 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14147 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14148 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14150 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14151 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14152 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14153 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14154 of a received message.
14155 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14157 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14158 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14159 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14160 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14162 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14163 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14164 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14165 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14167 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14168 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14169 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14170 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14171 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14174 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14175 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14176 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14177 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14179 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14180 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14181 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14182 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14183 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14185 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14186 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14187 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14188 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14189 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14191 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14192 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14193 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14194 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14195 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14197 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14198 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14199 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14202 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14203 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14204 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14205 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14207 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14208 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14209 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14210 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14212 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14213 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14214 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14215 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14217 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14218 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14219 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14220 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14222 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14223 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14224 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14225 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14226 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14228 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14229 .cindex "admin user"
14230 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14231 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14232 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14233 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14234 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14235 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14236 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14238 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14239 .cindex "domain literal"
14240 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14241 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14242 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14243 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14245 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14246 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14247 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14248 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14249 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14250 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14251 the local host's IP addresses.
14254 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14255 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14256 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14257 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14258 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14259 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14260 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14261 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14262 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14264 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14265 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14266 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14267 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14268 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14269 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14270 experiment if they wish.
14272 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14273 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14274 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14275 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14276 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14277 suitable setting is:
14279 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14280 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14282 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14284 dns_check_names_pattern =
14286 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14289 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14290 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14291 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14292 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14293 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14294 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14295 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14296 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14297 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14298 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14299 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14301 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14302 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14303 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14304 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14305 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14306 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14308 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14309 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14310 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14311 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14313 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14315 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14316 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14317 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14318 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14321 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14322 .cindex "thawing messages"
14323 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14324 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14325 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14326 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14327 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14328 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14330 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14331 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14332 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14335 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14336 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14337 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14339 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14341 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14342 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14345 .option bi_command main string unset
14347 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14348 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14349 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14350 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14353 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14354 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14355 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14356 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14357 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14358 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14361 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14362 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14363 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14364 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14366 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14367 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14368 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14369 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14370 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14371 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14372 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14373 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14374 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14375 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14377 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14378 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14379 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14380 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14381 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14382 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14383 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14384 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14385 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14386 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14388 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14389 during reception of a message.
14390 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14392 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14395 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14396 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14397 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14398 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14401 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14402 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14403 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14404 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14405 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14406 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14407 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14408 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14409 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14411 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14412 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14413 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14414 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14415 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14418 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14419 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14420 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14421 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14422 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14423 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14424 connection. A typical setting might be:
14426 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14428 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14430 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14432 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14435 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14436 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14437 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14438 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14439 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14440 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14443 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14444 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14445 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14446 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14449 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14450 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14451 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14452 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14455 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14456 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14457 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14458 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14461 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14462 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14463 callout verification. The default value is
14465 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14467 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14470 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14471 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14474 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14475 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14477 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14478 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14479 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14480 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14481 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14482 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14483 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14484 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14485 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14486 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14489 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14490 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14493 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14494 .cindex "checking disk space"
14495 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14496 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14497 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14498 message is accepted.
14500 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14501 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14502 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14503 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14504 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14505 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14506 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14507 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14510 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14511 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14513 check_spool_space = 100M
14514 check_spool_inodes = 100
14516 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14517 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14520 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14521 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14522 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14524 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14525 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14526 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14527 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14528 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14529 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14531 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14532 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14533 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14535 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14536 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14537 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14539 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14540 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14541 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14542 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14544 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14545 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14546 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14547 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14549 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14551 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14552 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14553 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14554 administrative user.
14555 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14557 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14558 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14559 .cindex memory debugging
14560 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14561 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14562 it should normally be left as default.
14564 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14565 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14566 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14567 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14568 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14569 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14571 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14572 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14573 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14574 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14575 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14576 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14577 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14579 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14580 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14582 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14583 .cindex "warning of delay"
14584 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14585 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14586 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14587 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14588 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14589 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14590 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14591 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14594 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14596 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14597 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14598 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14599 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14603 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14604 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14606 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14608 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14609 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14610 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14612 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14613 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14614 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14615 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14616 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14617 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14618 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14619 not sent. The default is:
14621 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14622 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14623 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14624 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14627 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14628 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14629 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14630 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14632 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14633 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14634 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14635 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14636 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14637 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14638 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14639 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14641 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14642 .cindex "load average"
14643 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14644 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14645 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14646 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14647 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14650 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14651 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14652 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14653 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14654 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14655 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14656 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14657 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14659 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14660 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14661 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14662 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14663 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14664 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14665 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14666 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14668 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14669 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14670 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14671 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14674 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14675 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14676 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14677 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14678 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14679 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14680 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14683 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14684 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14685 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14686 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14687 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14688 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
14691 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14692 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14693 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14694 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14695 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14696 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14697 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14698 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14699 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14700 by a setting such as this:
14702 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14704 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14705 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14706 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14707 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14708 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14709 options are applied after this global option.
14711 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14712 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14713 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14714 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14715 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14716 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14717 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14718 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14719 value of this option. The default pattern is
14721 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14722 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14724 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14725 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14726 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14727 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14728 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14731 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14732 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14733 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14735 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14736 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14737 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14738 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14741 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14742 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14743 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14744 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14745 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14746 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14748 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14751 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14752 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14753 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14754 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
14755 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14756 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14757 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14758 domain matches this list.
14760 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14761 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14762 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14765 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14766 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14767 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14768 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14769 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14770 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14771 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14772 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14773 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14774 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14775 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14776 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14778 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14781 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14782 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14785 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14786 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14787 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14788 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14789 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14790 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14791 match with this expanded domain list.
14793 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14794 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14795 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14796 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14797 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14798 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14800 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14801 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14802 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14804 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14805 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14806 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14807 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14808 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14810 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14811 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14812 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14813 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14814 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14815 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14816 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14817 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14820 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14822 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14823 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14824 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14827 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14828 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14829 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14830 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14832 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14833 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14834 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14835 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14836 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14837 and accepted from, these hosts.
14838 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14839 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14840 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14841 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14844 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14845 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14846 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14847 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14848 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14849 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14851 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14853 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14854 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14856 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14857 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14858 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14859 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14860 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14861 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14862 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14863 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14864 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14867 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14868 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14869 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14870 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14871 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14872 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14873 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14874 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14875 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14877 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14878 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14879 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14880 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14881 are examined. For example:
14883 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14884 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14885 postmaster@mydomain.example
14887 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14888 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14889 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14890 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14891 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14892 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14893 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14896 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14897 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14898 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14900 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14902 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14903 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14904 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14905 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14906 overrides the default.
14908 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14909 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14910 and warning messages. For example:
14912 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14914 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14915 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14916 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14917 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14921 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14923 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14924 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14927 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14928 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14929 .cindex "Exim group"
14930 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14931 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14932 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14933 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14934 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14938 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14939 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14940 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14941 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14942 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14943 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14945 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14946 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14947 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14948 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14951 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14952 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14953 .cindex "Exim user"
14954 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14955 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14956 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14957 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14959 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14960 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14961 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14962 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14965 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14966 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14967 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14968 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14971 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14972 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14974 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14975 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14977 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14978 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14979 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14980 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14981 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14982 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14983 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14984 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14985 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14986 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14990 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14991 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14992 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14993 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14994 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14995 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14996 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14997 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15000 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15001 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15002 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15003 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15007 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15008 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15009 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15010 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15011 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15012 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15013 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15014 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15015 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15016 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15017 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15018 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15019 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15020 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15021 logging that you require.
15024 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15026 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15027 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15028 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15029 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15030 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15031 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15032 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15033 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15035 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15036 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15037 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15040 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15041 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15042 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15043 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15045 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15049 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15050 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15053 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15054 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15055 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15056 implementations of TLS.
15059 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15060 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15061 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15064 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15069 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15070 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15071 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15072 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15073 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15074 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15078 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15079 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15080 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15081 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15082 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15083 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15084 sections are rejected.
15087 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15088 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15089 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15090 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15091 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15092 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15093 zero means &"no limit"&.
15098 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15099 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15100 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15101 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15102 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15103 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15104 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15105 if you want to do semantic checking.
15106 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15110 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15111 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15112 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15113 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15114 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15115 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15116 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15118 helo_allow_chars = _
15120 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15123 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15124 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15125 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15126 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15127 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15128 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15129 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15133 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15134 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15135 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15136 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15137 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15138 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15139 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15140 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15141 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15142 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15143 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15144 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15146 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15147 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15148 EHLO command either:
15151 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15153 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15154 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15155 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15156 calling host address, or
15158 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15161 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15162 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15163 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15165 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15166 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15167 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15169 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15170 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15171 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15172 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15173 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15174 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15175 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15176 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15177 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15180 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15181 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15182 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15183 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15184 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15185 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15186 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15187 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15188 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15190 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15191 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15192 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15193 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15194 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15196 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15197 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15198 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15199 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15202 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15203 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15204 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15205 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15206 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15207 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15208 default configuration file contains
15212 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15213 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15215 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15216 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15217 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15219 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15220 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15221 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15222 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15223 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15224 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15227 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15228 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15229 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15230 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15231 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15234 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15235 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15236 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15237 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15241 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15242 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15243 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15244 as soon as the connection is made.
15245 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15246 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15247 connections immediately.
15249 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15250 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15251 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15252 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15253 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15256 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15257 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15258 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15259 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15260 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15261 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15262 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15263 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15264 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15266 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15268 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15272 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15273 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15274 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15275 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15278 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15279 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15280 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15281 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15282 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15284 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15285 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15287 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15288 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15289 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15290 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15291 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15292 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15293 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15296 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15297 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15298 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15299 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15300 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15304 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15305 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15306 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15307 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15308 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15309 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15311 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15312 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15313 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15314 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15315 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15316 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15317 for frozen messages. For example,
15319 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15321 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15322 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15323 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15324 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15325 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15326 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15329 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15330 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15331 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15332 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15333 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15334 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15335 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15336 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15337 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15338 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15341 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15342 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15344 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15345 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15346 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15347 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15348 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15349 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15350 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15351 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15352 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15354 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15355 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15357 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15358 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15359 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15360 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15362 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15363 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15364 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15367 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15368 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15369 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15373 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15374 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15375 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15376 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15380 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15381 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15382 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15383 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15384 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15385 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15386 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15387 and constrained to be a directory.
15390 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15391 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15392 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15393 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15394 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15395 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15396 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15397 and constrained to be a file.
15400 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15401 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15402 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15403 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15404 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15405 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15408 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15409 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15410 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15411 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15412 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15413 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15414 identity to be proven.
15417 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15418 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15419 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15420 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15421 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15424 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15425 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15426 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15427 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15428 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15432 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15433 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15434 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15435 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15436 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15437 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15441 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15442 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15443 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15444 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15445 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15447 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15448 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15449 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15452 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15453 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15454 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15455 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15456 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15457 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15458 has been built with LDAP support.
15462 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15463 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15464 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15465 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15466 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15467 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15468 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15470 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15471 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15472 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15474 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15475 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15476 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15477 and the default qualify domain.
15479 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15480 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15481 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15482 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15484 .cindex "envelope sender"
15485 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15486 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15487 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15489 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15490 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15491 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15496 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15497 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15498 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15499 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15500 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15501 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15502 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15505 local_from_prefix = *-
15507 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15509 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15511 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15512 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15516 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15517 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15520 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15521 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15522 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15523 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15524 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15525 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15526 &%local_interfaces%& is
15528 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15530 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15532 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15535 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15536 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15537 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15538 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15539 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15540 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15541 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15542 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15546 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15547 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15548 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15549 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15550 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15551 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15552 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15553 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15558 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15559 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15560 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15561 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15562 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15563 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15564 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15565 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15566 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15567 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15568 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15569 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15570 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15571 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15572 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15576 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15577 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15578 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15579 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15580 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15581 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15582 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15583 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15584 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15585 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15586 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15587 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15588 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15589 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15590 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15593 .option log_selector main string unset
15594 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15595 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15596 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15597 minus characters. For example:
15599 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15601 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15602 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15605 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15606 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15607 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15608 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15609 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15610 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15611 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15612 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15613 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15614 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15615 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15616 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15617 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15620 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15621 .cindex "too many open files"
15622 .cindex "open files, too many"
15623 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15624 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15625 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15626 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15627 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15628 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15629 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15630 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15631 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15632 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15633 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15634 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15637 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15638 .cindex "length of login name"
15639 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15640 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15641 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15642 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15643 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15644 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15647 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15648 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15649 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15650 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15651 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15652 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15653 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15654 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15657 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15658 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15659 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15660 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15661 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15662 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15663 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15666 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15667 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15668 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15669 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15670 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15671 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15672 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15673 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15674 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15675 empty string, the option is ignored.
15678 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15679 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15680 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15681 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15682 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15683 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15684 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15685 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15686 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15687 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15688 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15689 colons will become hyphens.
15692 .option message_logs main boolean true
15693 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15694 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15695 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15696 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15697 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15698 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15699 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15700 which is not affected by this option.
15703 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15704 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15705 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15706 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15707 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15708 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15709 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15710 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15711 optionally followed by K or M.
15713 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15714 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15715 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15716 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15717 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15719 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15720 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15721 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15722 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15723 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15724 message that an individual transport can process.
15726 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15727 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15728 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15729 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15730 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15731 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15732 some problems may result.
15734 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15735 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15736 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15739 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15740 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15741 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15743 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15745 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15746 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15747 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15748 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15749 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15752 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15753 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15754 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15755 contains a full description of this facility.
15759 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15760 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15761 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15762 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15763 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15766 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15767 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15768 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15769 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15770 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15773 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15774 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15775 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15776 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15777 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15779 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15780 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15783 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15785 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15786 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15790 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15791 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15792 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15793 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15794 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15796 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15797 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15798 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15799 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15800 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15801 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15802 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15804 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15805 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15806 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15807 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15808 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15810 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15812 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15813 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15814 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15815 some now infamous attacks.
15819 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15820 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15821 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15823 # Disable older protocol versions:
15824 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15827 Possible options may include:
15831 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15833 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15835 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15839 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15841 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15843 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15845 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15847 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15849 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15853 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15867 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15871 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15873 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15875 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15877 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15881 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15884 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15885 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15886 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15887 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15888 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15889 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15892 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15893 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15894 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15895 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15896 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15899 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15900 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15901 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15902 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15903 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15904 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15905 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15906 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15907 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15908 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15911 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15912 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15913 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15914 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15915 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15916 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15917 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15920 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15922 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15923 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15926 .option perl_startup main string unset
15928 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15929 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15931 .option perl_startup main boolean false
15933 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15936 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15937 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15938 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15939 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15940 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15941 PostgreSQL support.
15944 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15945 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15946 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15947 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15948 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15951 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15953 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15955 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15956 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15957 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15960 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15961 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15962 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15963 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15964 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15965 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15966 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15967 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15968 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15971 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15972 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15973 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15974 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15975 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15976 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15977 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15978 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15980 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15981 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15982 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15983 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15984 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15985 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15986 volume of mail. Use with care!
15989 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15990 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15991 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15992 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15993 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15994 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15995 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15996 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15997 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15998 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16000 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16001 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16002 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16003 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16004 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16005 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16008 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16009 .cindex "printing characters"
16010 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16011 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16012 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16013 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16014 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16015 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16018 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16019 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16020 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16021 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16022 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16026 .option process_log_path main string unset
16027 .cindex "process log path"
16028 .cindex "log" "process log"
16029 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16030 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16031 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16032 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16033 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16034 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16035 different spool directories.
16038 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16039 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16043 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16044 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16045 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16048 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16049 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16050 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16051 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16052 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16053 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16054 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16055 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16056 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16058 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16059 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16060 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16061 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16062 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16063 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16064 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16067 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16068 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16069 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16073 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16074 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16075 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16076 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16077 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16078 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16079 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16080 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16083 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16084 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16086 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16087 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16088 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16089 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16092 .option queue_only main boolean false
16093 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16094 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16095 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16096 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16097 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16098 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16100 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16101 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16102 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16103 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16106 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16107 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16108 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16109 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16110 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16111 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16112 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16113 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16114 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16116 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16118 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16119 &_/some/file_& exists.
16122 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16123 .cindex "load average"
16124 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16125 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16126 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16127 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16128 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16129 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16130 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16133 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16134 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16135 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16136 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16139 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16140 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16141 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16142 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16143 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16144 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16145 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16146 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16147 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16148 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16149 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16150 re-evaluated for each message.
16153 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16154 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16155 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16156 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16157 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16158 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16161 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16162 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16163 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16164 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16165 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16166 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16167 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16168 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16169 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16170 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16171 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16172 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16173 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16177 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16178 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16179 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16180 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16181 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16182 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16183 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16184 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16185 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16187 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16188 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16189 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16190 the daemon's command line.
16192 .cindex queues named
16193 .cindex "named queues"
16194 To set limits for different named queues use
16195 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16197 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16198 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16199 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16200 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16201 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16202 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16203 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16204 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16205 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16206 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16207 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16208 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16209 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16213 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16214 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16215 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16216 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16217 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16218 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16219 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16221 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16222 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16223 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16224 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16225 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16226 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16227 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16228 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16229 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16230 header lines. The default setting is:
16233 received_header_text = Received: \
16234 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16235 {${if def:sender_ident \
16236 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16237 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16238 by $primary_hostname \
16239 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16240 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16241 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16242 ${if def:sender_address \
16243 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16244 id $message_exim_id\
16245 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16248 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16249 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16250 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16251 header lines such as the following:
16253 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16254 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16255 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16256 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16257 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16258 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16259 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16261 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16262 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16263 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16264 message was accepted.
16267 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16268 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16269 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16270 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16271 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16272 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16273 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16274 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16277 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16278 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16279 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16280 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16281 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16282 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16283 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16284 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16285 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16286 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16287 option was not set.
16290 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16291 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16292 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16293 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16294 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16295 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16296 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16297 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16300 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16301 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16302 RCPT commands in a single message.
16305 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16306 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16307 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16308 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16309 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16310 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16311 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16314 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16315 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16316 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16317 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16318 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16319 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16320 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16321 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16322 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16323 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16324 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16325 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16326 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16327 tagged with its process id.
16329 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16330 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16331 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16332 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16335 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16336 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16337 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16338 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16339 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16340 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16341 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16342 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16343 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16344 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16345 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16347 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16348 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16349 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16350 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16353 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16354 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16355 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16356 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16357 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16359 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16361 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16362 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16365 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16366 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16367 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16368 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16369 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16373 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16374 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16375 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16376 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16377 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16378 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16379 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16383 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16384 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16385 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16386 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16387 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16388 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16389 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16390 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16391 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16392 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16395 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16396 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16399 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16401 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16402 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16403 an item in the list.
16404 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16407 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16408 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16409 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16410 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16411 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16414 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16415 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16416 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16417 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16418 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16419 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16420 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16421 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16422 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16423 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16425 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16426 .cindex "environment"
16427 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16428 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16429 default list is empty,
16432 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16433 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16434 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16435 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16436 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16437 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16438 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16442 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16443 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16444 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16445 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16446 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16447 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16448 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16449 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16450 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16451 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16452 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16456 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16457 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16458 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16460 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16461 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16462 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16463 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16464 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16465 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16467 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16468 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16469 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16470 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16473 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16474 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16475 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16476 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16477 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16478 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16479 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16480 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16482 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16483 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16484 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16485 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16486 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16487 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16488 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16489 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16492 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16493 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16494 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16495 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16499 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16500 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16501 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16502 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16503 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16504 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16505 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16506 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16507 . the option name to split.
16509 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16510 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16511 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16512 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16513 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16514 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16515 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16516 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16517 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16521 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16522 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16523 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16524 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16525 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16526 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16527 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16528 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16529 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16530 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16531 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16533 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16534 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16535 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16536 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16537 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16538 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16542 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16543 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16544 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16545 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16546 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16547 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16548 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16549 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16550 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16551 to all messages received in the same connection.
16553 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16554 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16555 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16556 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16559 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16561 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16562 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16563 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16564 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16565 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16566 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16567 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16568 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16569 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16570 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16571 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16572 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16573 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16576 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16577 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16578 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16579 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16580 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16581 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16582 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16583 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16584 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16585 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16586 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16589 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16590 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16591 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16592 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16595 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16596 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16597 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16598 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16599 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16600 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16601 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16602 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16603 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16605 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16606 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16607 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16608 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16610 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16611 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16612 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16613 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16614 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16617 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16618 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16621 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16622 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16623 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16624 &%helo_data%& value.
16626 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16627 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16628 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16629 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16630 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16631 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16632 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16634 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16635 $version_number $tod_full
16637 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16638 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16639 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16640 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16641 multiline response).
16644 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16645 .cindex "checking disk space"
16646 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16647 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16648 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16649 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16650 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16651 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16652 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16655 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16656 .cindex "connection backlog"
16657 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16658 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16659 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16660 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16661 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16662 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16663 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16664 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16665 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16666 attacks by SYN flooding.
16669 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16670 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16671 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16672 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16673 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16674 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16675 fewer, but they still exist.
16677 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16678 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16679 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16680 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16681 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16682 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16683 does detect many instances.
16685 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16686 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16687 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16688 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16692 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16693 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16694 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16695 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16696 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16697 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16698 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16699 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16702 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16703 $sender_host_address
16705 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16706 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16707 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16708 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16709 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16713 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16714 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16715 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16716 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16717 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16720 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16721 .cindex "load average"
16722 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16723 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16724 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16725 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16726 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16727 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16731 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16732 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16733 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16734 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16735 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16737 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16739 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16740 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16741 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16742 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16743 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16745 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16746 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16747 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16748 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16749 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16750 not count towards the limit.
16754 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16755 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16756 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16757 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16758 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16761 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16762 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16766 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16767 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16768 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16769 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16770 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16771 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16774 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16775 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16776 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16777 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16779 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16780 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16781 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16782 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16786 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16788 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16789 fractional parts are allowed here.
16791 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16793 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16794 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16797 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16798 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16800 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16801 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16803 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16804 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16805 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16806 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16809 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16810 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16813 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16814 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16817 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16818 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16819 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16820 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16821 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16822 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16823 the message is abandoned.
16824 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16826 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16827 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16829 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16830 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16832 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16833 expanded before use and may depend on
16834 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16838 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16839 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16840 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16841 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16842 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16845 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16846 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16847 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16850 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16851 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16852 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16853 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16854 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16855 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16856 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16857 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16858 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16859 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16861 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16862 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16866 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16867 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16868 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16869 the availability thereof is advertised in
16870 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16871 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16874 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
16875 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16876 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16877 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16882 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
16883 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
16884 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
16889 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16890 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16891 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16892 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16893 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16894 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16895 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16896 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16897 arrival of the message.
16899 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16900 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16901 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16902 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16903 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16905 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16906 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16907 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16908 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16909 automatically deleted.
16911 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16912 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16913 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16914 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16915 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16916 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16917 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16918 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16919 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16922 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16923 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16924 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16925 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16926 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16927 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16928 &$primary_hostname$&.
16930 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16931 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16932 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16933 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16934 as failures in the configuration file.
16936 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16937 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16939 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16940 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16941 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternate format
16942 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16943 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16944 Currently it is only done for messages received using the EMSTP CHUNKING
16947 The following variables will not have useful values:
16949 $max_received_linelength
16954 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
16955 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
16956 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
16957 will need to be aware of the potential different format.
16959 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
16960 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
16961 The transmission benefit is maintained.
16963 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16964 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16965 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16966 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16968 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16969 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16970 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16971 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16972 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16973 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16975 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16976 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16977 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16978 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16979 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16980 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16981 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16984 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16985 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16986 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16987 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16988 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16989 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16990 domain causes a syntax error.
16991 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16995 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16996 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16997 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16998 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16999 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17000 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17001 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17002 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17003 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17004 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17005 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17006 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17009 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17010 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17011 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17012 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17013 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17014 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17015 details of Exim's logging.
17018 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17019 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17020 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17021 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17022 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17023 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17024 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17028 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17029 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17030 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17031 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17032 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17036 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17037 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17038 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17039 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17040 details of Exim's logging.
17043 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17044 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17045 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17046 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17047 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17048 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17049 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17050 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17051 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17052 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17053 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17054 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17057 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17058 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17059 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17060 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17061 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17062 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17065 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17066 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17067 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17068 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17069 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17071 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17072 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17073 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17074 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17075 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17077 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17078 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17079 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17080 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17081 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17082 contains the pipe command.
17085 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17086 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17087 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17088 is used in a system filter.
17091 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17092 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17093 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17094 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17095 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17096 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17097 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17098 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17099 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17100 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17102 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17103 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17104 transport option overrides.
17107 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17108 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17109 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17110 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17111 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17112 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17113 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17114 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17115 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17116 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17117 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17118 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17122 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17123 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17124 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17125 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17126 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17127 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17128 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17129 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17130 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17131 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17133 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17134 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17135 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17138 .option timezone main string unset
17139 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17140 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17141 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17142 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17143 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17144 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17148 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17149 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17150 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17151 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17152 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17153 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17156 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17157 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17158 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17159 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17160 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17161 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17162 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17163 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17164 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17165 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17166 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17169 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17170 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17171 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17172 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17173 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17175 The server's private key is also
17176 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17177 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17179 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17180 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17181 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17182 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17184 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17185 separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17187 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
17188 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17190 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17191 when a list of more than one file is used.
17193 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17194 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17195 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17196 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17198 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17199 generated for every connection.
17201 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17202 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17203 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17204 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17205 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17208 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17210 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17211 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17212 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17215 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17218 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17219 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17220 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17221 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17222 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17223 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17225 The value must be at least 1024.
17227 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17228 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17229 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17231 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17234 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17235 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17236 larger prime than requested.
17239 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17240 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17241 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17242 to be used by Exim.
17244 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17245 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17246 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17247 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17249 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17250 then it names a file from which DH
17251 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17252 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17253 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17254 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17255 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17256 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17258 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17261 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17262 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17263 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17264 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17266 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17267 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17269 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17270 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17271 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17273 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17274 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17275 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17276 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17277 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17279 The available standard primes are:
17280 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17281 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17282 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17283 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17285 The available additional primes are:
17286 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17288 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17289 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17290 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17291 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17292 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17294 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17295 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17296 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17298 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17299 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17300 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17301 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17302 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17305 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17306 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17307 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17308 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17309 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17310 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17311 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17314 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17315 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17316 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17317 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17319 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17320 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17321 for valid selections.
17323 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17324 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17325 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17327 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17330 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17331 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17332 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17334 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17335 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17336 Certificate Authority.
17338 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17341 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17342 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17343 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17347 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17350 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17351 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17352 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17353 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17357 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17358 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17359 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17360 files which contains the server's private keys.
17361 If this option is unset, or if
17362 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17363 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17364 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17366 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17369 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17370 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17371 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17372 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17373 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17374 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17378 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17379 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17380 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17381 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17382 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17383 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17384 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17385 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17386 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17387 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17388 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17391 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17392 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17393 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17394 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17397 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17398 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17399 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17400 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17402 or the absolute path to
17403 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17404 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17406 The "system" value for the option will use a
17407 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17408 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17409 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17412 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17413 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17415 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17417 either by file or directory
17418 are added to those given by the system default location.
17420 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17421 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17422 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17423 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17424 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17425 use the explicit directory version.
17427 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17429 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17433 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17434 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17435 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17436 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17437 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17438 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17439 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17440 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17442 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17443 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17444 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17445 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17446 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17447 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17448 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17450 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17451 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17452 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17453 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17454 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17455 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17456 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17459 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17463 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17464 .cindex "trusted groups"
17465 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17466 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17467 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17468 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17469 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17470 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17471 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17474 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17475 .cindex "trusted users"
17476 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17477 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17478 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17479 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17480 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17481 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17482 Exim user are trusted.
17484 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17485 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17486 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17487 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17488 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17489 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17490 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17491 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17492 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17495 .option unknown_username main string unset
17496 See &%unknown_login%&.
17498 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17499 .cindex "trusted users"
17500 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17501 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17502 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17503 .cindex "envelope sender"
17504 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17505 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17506 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17507 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17508 is used) is ignored.
17510 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17511 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17513 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17515 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17516 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17517 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17518 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17519 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17520 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17521 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17522 followed by a hyphen
17523 by a setting like this:
17525 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17527 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17528 restriction, you can use
17530 untrusted_set_sender = *
17532 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17533 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17534 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17535 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17536 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17537 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17538 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17539 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17541 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17542 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17543 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17544 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17548 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17549 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17550 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17551 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17552 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17553 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17554 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17555 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17556 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17557 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17559 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17560 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17562 The pattern can be seen by running
17564 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17566 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17567 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17568 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17569 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17570 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17571 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17574 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17575 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17578 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17579 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17580 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17581 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17582 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17583 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17584 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17585 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17588 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17589 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17590 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17591 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17592 .ecindex IIDconfima
17593 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17601 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17602 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17603 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17604 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17605 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
17607 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17608 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17609 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17610 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17611 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17615 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17616 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17617 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17618 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17619 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17620 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17621 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17623 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17624 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17625 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17626 routers, and the eventual transport.
17628 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17629 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17630 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17631 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17632 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17634 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17635 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17636 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17637 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17638 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17640 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17641 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17642 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17644 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17646 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17648 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17650 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17651 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17653 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17654 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17655 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17656 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17657 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17658 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17659 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17663 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17665 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17666 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17667 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17668 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17669 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17674 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17675 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17676 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17677 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17678 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17679 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17680 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17681 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17682 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17683 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17686 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17688 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17691 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17693 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17694 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17695 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17696 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17699 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17700 .cindex "case of local parts"
17701 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17702 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17703 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17704 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17705 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17706 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17707 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17710 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17711 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17712 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17713 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17714 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17715 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17716 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17717 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17718 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17720 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17721 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17722 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17723 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17727 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17728 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17729 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17730 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17732 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17733 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17734 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17735 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17736 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17737 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17738 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17739 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17740 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17741 the router is skipped.
17743 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17744 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17745 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17746 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17747 setting to achieve this. For example:
17749 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17751 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17752 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17753 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17757 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17758 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17759 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17760 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17761 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17762 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17763 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17764 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17766 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17767 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17769 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17770 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17772 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17773 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17774 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17776 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17778 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17780 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17783 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17785 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17786 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17790 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17791 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17792 be specified using &%condition%&.
17794 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17795 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17796 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17797 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17798 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17799 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17800 Router rules processing behavior.
17802 This is best illustrated in an example:
17804 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17805 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17807 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17810 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17813 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17814 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17815 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17816 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17817 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17818 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17819 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17820 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17822 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17823 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17824 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17825 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17828 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17829 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17830 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17831 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17832 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17835 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17836 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17837 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17838 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17839 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17840 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17841 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17842 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17843 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17844 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17845 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17846 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17847 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17848 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17852 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17853 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17854 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17855 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17856 transport option of the same name.
17858 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17859 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17860 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17861 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17862 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17863 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17864 the dnssec request bit set.
17865 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17867 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17868 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17869 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17870 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17871 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17872 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17873 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17874 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17875 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17878 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17879 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17880 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17881 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17882 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17883 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17884 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17885 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17889 .option driver routers string unset
17890 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17894 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17895 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17896 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17897 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17898 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17899 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17900 Not effective on redirect routers.
17904 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17905 .cindex "envelope sender"
17906 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17907 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17908 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17909 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17910 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17911 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17912 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17914 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17915 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17916 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17919 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17920 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17921 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17922 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17924 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17925 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17926 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17927 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17933 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17934 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17935 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17936 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17937 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17939 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17940 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17941 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17942 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17943 setting &%return_path%&.
17945 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17946 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17947 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17951 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17952 .cindex "address" "testing"
17953 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17954 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17955 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17956 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17957 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17958 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17959 on for the system alias file.
17960 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17963 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17964 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17965 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17969 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17970 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17971 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17972 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17976 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17977 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17978 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17982 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17983 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17984 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17988 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17989 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17990 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17991 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17992 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17993 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17994 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17995 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17996 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17998 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17999 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18000 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18001 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18002 transport for further details.
18005 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18006 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18007 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18008 .cindex "transport" "local"
18009 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18010 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18011 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18013 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18014 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18015 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18016 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18017 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18021 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18022 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18023 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18024 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18025 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18026 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18027 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18028 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18029 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18030 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18031 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18032 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18033 &"see"& the added header lines.
18035 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18036 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18037 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18038 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18040 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18041 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18043 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18044 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18046 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18047 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18048 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18049 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18050 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18051 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18052 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18053 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18054 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18055 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18059 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18060 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18061 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18062 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18063 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18064 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18065 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18066 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18067 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18068 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18069 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18070 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18071 &"see"& the original header lines.
18073 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18074 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18075 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18078 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18079 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18081 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18082 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18084 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18085 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18086 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18087 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18089 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18090 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18091 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18095 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18096 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18097 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18098 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18099 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18100 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18101 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18104 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18108 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18110 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18111 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18112 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18113 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18114 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18115 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18117 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18118 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18120 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18121 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18123 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18124 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18126 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18127 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18128 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18129 domain that is being routed.
18131 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18132 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18135 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18136 .cindex "additional groups"
18137 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18138 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18139 .cindex "transport" "local"
18140 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18141 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18142 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18143 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18144 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18148 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18149 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18150 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18151 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18152 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18153 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18156 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18157 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18158 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18159 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18160 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18161 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18162 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18163 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18164 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18166 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18167 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18168 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18169 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18170 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18171 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18172 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18173 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18174 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18175 the relevant transport.
18177 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18178 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18179 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18182 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18183 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18184 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18185 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18186 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18190 local_part_prefix = real-
18192 transport = local_delivery
18194 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18195 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18197 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18198 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18201 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18202 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18203 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18204 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18207 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18208 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18212 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18213 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18214 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18215 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18216 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18217 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18218 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18219 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18220 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18224 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18225 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18229 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18230 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18231 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18232 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18233 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18235 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18236 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18239 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18241 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18242 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18243 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18244 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18245 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18246 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18247 each virtual domain:
18251 local_parts = postmaster
18252 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18256 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18257 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18258 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18259 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18260 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18261 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18262 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18263 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18264 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18265 redirect addresses.
18269 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18270 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18271 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18272 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18273 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18274 delivery to be deferred.
18276 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18277 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18279 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18280 means of the setting
18284 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18285 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18286 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18288 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18289 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18290 controls what happens next.
18293 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18294 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18295 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18296 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18297 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18298 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18299 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18300 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18302 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18303 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18304 applies to all of them.
18308 .option pass_router routers string unset
18309 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18310 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18311 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18312 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18313 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18314 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18315 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18316 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18317 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18318 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18322 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18323 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18324 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18325 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18326 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18327 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18329 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18330 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18331 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18332 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18336 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18337 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18338 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18339 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18340 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18341 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18342 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18344 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18345 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18346 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18347 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18349 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18350 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18351 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18352 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18353 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18356 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18357 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18360 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18361 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18362 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18363 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18364 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18365 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18366 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18367 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18369 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18370 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18371 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18372 operates as follows:
18374 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18375 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18376 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18377 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18380 require_files = mail:/some/file
18381 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18383 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18384 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18386 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18387 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18388 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18389 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18391 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18392 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18393 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18394 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18395 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18397 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18398 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18399 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18400 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18401 check again in that process.
18403 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18404 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18405 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18406 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18407 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18408 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18409 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18411 require_files = +/some/file
18413 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18414 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18415 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18419 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18420 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18421 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18422 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18423 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18424 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18425 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18426 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18429 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18430 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18431 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18432 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18433 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18436 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18437 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18438 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18442 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18443 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18444 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18446 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18447 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18448 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18449 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18450 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18451 cause the router to defer.
18453 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18454 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18456 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18458 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18459 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18461 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18462 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18463 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18464 of these values that is set:
18467 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18469 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18471 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18473 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18476 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18477 router, but not for the transport.
18481 .option self routers string freeze
18482 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18483 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18484 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18485 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18486 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18487 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18489 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18490 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18491 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18492 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18493 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18495 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18496 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18497 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18498 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18499 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18504 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18506 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18507 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18508 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18509 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18511 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18512 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18513 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18518 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18519 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18520 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18521 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18522 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18523 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18529 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18530 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18531 be passed to the next router.
18534 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18537 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18538 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18539 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18540 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18541 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18542 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18547 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18548 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18549 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18550 address matches something on the list.
18551 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18554 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18555 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18556 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18557 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18558 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18559 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18560 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18564 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18565 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18566 .cindex "packet radio"
18567 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18568 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18569 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18570 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18571 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18572 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18573 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18574 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18576 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18577 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18578 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18579 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18580 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18581 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18582 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18583 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18584 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18585 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18587 translate_ip_address = \
18588 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18591 The file would contain lines like
18593 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18594 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18596 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18601 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18602 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18603 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18604 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18605 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18606 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18607 delivery is deferred.
18609 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18610 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18611 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18615 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18616 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18617 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18618 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18619 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18620 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18621 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18622 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18623 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18624 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18625 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18631 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18632 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18633 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18634 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18635 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18636 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18637 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18638 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18639 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18640 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18642 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18643 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18644 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18645 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18646 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18648 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18654 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18655 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18656 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18657 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18658 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18659 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18660 delivery to be deferred.
18662 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18663 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18664 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18665 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18666 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18667 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18669 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18670 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18671 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18672 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18673 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18674 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18675 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18676 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18678 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18679 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18680 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18681 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18682 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18683 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18684 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18685 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18686 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18687 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18689 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18690 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18691 subsequent routers.
18694 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18695 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18696 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18697 .cindex "transport" "local"
18698 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18699 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18700 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18701 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18702 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18703 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18704 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18705 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18706 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18707 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18708 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18709 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18713 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18714 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18715 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18718 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18719 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18721 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18722 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18723 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18724 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18725 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18726 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18727 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18729 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18730 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18731 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18735 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18736 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18738 delivering in cutthrough mode
18739 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18740 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18742 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18745 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18746 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18747 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18748 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18750 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18751 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18752 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18759 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18760 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18762 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18763 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18764 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18765 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18766 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18767 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18768 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18769 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18770 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18774 domains = mydomain.example
18776 transport = local_delivery
18778 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18779 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18780 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18781 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18791 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18792 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18793 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18794 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18795 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18796 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18798 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18799 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18800 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18801 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18804 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18805 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18806 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18808 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18810 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18811 generic option, the router declines.
18813 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18814 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18815 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18817 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18818 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18819 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18820 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18821 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18822 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18825 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18826 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18827 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18828 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18829 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18830 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18832 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18833 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18834 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18835 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18836 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18837 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18838 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18839 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18840 case routing fails.
18843 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18844 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18845 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18846 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18847 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18849 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18850 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18852 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18854 The domain does not exist in DNS
18856 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18857 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18858 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18860 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18862 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18864 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18865 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18867 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18868 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18870 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18871 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18873 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18874 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18880 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18881 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18882 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18884 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18885 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18886 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18887 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18888 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18889 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18890 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18893 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18894 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18895 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18896 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18897 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18898 required. For example,
18902 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18903 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18904 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18905 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18906 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18909 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18910 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18911 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18912 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18913 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18914 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18916 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18917 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18918 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18919 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18920 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18921 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18922 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18923 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18925 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18926 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18931 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18932 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18933 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18934 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18935 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18936 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18937 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18938 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18943 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
18944 .cindex IPv6 disabling
18945 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
18946 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18947 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18948 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18949 only A records are used.
18951 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
18952 .cindex IPv4 preference
18953 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
18954 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18955 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18956 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18957 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
18960 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18961 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18962 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18963 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18964 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18965 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18966 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18969 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18971 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18972 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18973 the address record.
18976 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18977 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18978 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18979 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18984 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18985 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18986 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18987 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18988 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18989 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18990 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18991 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18992 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18997 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18998 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18999 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19000 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19001 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19002 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19003 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19004 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19005 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19006 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19007 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19009 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19010 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19013 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19014 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19015 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19016 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19017 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19021 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19022 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19023 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19024 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19025 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19026 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19027 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19028 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19030 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19031 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19032 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19033 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19034 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19035 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19036 without processing them independently,
19037 provided the following conditions are met:
19040 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19041 &%headers_remove%&.
19043 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19050 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19051 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19052 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19053 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19054 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19055 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19056 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19057 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19058 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19059 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19061 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19062 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19067 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19068 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19069 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19070 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19075 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19076 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19077 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19078 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19081 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19083 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19084 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19085 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19086 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19087 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19088 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19091 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19092 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19093 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19094 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19095 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19097 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19098 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19099 such as that implied by
19103 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19104 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19105 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19106 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19117 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19119 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19120 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19121 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19122 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19123 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19124 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19125 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19126 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19127 router handles the address
19131 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19132 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19133 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19135 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19137 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19138 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19140 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19141 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19142 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19143 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19145 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19146 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19147 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19148 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19152 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19153 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19155 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19156 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19157 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19158 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19159 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19160 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19163 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19165 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19167 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19168 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19169 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19170 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19171 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19172 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19173 must not be specified for it.
19175 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19176 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19177 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19178 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19179 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19180 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19181 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19184 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19185 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19186 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19187 delivery to the address is deferred.
19190 .option port iplookup integer 0
19191 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19192 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19196 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19197 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19198 protocols is to be used.
19201 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19202 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19205 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19207 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19208 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19211 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19212 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19213 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19214 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19215 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19216 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19217 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19218 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19221 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19222 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19223 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19224 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19225 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19226 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19227 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19228 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19229 following could be used:
19231 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19232 reroute = $local_part@$1
19235 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19236 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19237 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19238 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19243 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19244 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19246 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19247 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19248 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19249 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19250 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19251 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19252 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19253 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19254 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19255 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19257 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19258 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19259 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19260 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19261 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19262 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19263 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19266 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19267 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19268 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19269 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19270 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19271 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19272 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19275 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19276 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19277 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19278 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19279 below, following the list of private options.
19282 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19284 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19285 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19287 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19288 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19290 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19291 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19292 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19293 of the following values:
19302 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19303 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19304 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19307 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19308 router only if &%more%& is true.
19310 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19311 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19312 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19313 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19315 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19316 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19317 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19320 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19321 .cindex "randomized host list"
19322 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19323 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19324 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19325 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19326 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19327 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19328 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19329 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19331 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19332 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19333 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19334 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19336 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19338 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19339 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19340 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19341 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19342 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19345 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19346 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19347 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19350 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19352 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19353 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19357 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19358 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19359 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19360 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19363 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19364 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19365 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19366 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19367 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19368 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19369 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19370 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19372 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19373 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19374 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19375 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19376 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19377 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19378 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19379 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19384 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19385 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19386 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19387 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19388 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19389 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19391 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19393 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19397 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19398 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19400 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19401 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19402 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19403 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19404 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19405 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19406 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19407 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19408 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19409 in a &%route_list%&).
19411 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19412 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19413 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19414 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19418 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19419 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19420 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19421 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19422 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19423 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19424 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19427 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19428 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19430 This data can be accessed by setting
19432 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19434 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19435 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19436 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19437 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19438 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19443 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19444 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19445 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19446 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19447 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19448 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19449 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19451 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19452 variables are set during its expansion:
19455 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19456 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19457 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19459 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19462 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19464 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19467 .vindex "&$value$&"
19468 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19469 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19471 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19475 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19476 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19480 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19481 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19482 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19483 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19484 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19485 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19488 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19489 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19490 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19492 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19493 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19496 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19497 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19498 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19499 number follows. For example:
19501 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19505 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19506 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19507 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19508 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19509 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19512 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19513 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19514 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19515 records in the DNS. For example:
19517 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19519 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19522 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19524 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19525 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19526 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19527 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19528 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19529 happens is controlled by the
19530 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19531 &%self%& option of the router.
19533 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19534 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19535 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19536 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19537 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19538 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19539 defined by MX preferences.
19541 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19542 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19543 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19545 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19546 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19547 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19548 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19550 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19551 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19554 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19555 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19556 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19558 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19559 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19563 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19564 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19565 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19566 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19567 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19568 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19569 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19572 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19573 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19575 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19576 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19578 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19579 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19580 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19582 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19583 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19584 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19587 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19589 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19595 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19596 domain2 host4:host5
19598 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19599 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19600 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19601 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19604 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19605 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19606 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19607 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19610 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19611 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19616 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19617 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19620 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19621 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19625 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19626 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19627 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19630 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19631 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19632 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19633 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19635 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19637 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19638 your first router something like this:
19641 driver = manualroute
19642 domains = !+local_domains
19643 transport = remote_smtp
19644 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19646 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19647 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19648 they are tried in order
19649 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19650 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19653 driver = manualroute
19654 transport = remote_smtp
19655 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19657 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19658 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19659 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19660 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19661 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19662 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19663 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19664 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19667 .cindex "mail hub example"
19668 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19669 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19670 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19671 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19672 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19673 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19674 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19675 lookup is easier to manage.
19677 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19678 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19682 driver = manualroute
19683 transport = remote_smtp
19684 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19686 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19687 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19688 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19689 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19690 domain can be used to find the host:
19693 driver = manualroute
19694 transport = remote_smtp
19695 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19697 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19698 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19699 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19703 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19704 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19705 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19706 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19707 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19708 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19711 driver = manualroute
19712 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19713 route_list = saved.domain.example
19715 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19716 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19717 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19720 driver = manualroute
19722 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19723 *.saved.domain2.example \
19724 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19727 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19729 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19730 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19731 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19732 the address if the lookup fails.
19735 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19736 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19737 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19738 one way it can be done:
19744 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19745 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19746 return_fail_output = true
19751 driver = manualroute
19753 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19755 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19757 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19759 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19760 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19761 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19763 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19764 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19773 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19774 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19776 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19777 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19778 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19779 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19780 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19781 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19782 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19783 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19784 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19785 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19787 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19789 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19790 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19791 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19792 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19793 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19796 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19797 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19798 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19799 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19800 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19801 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19804 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19805 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19806 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19807 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19808 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19809 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19810 not set, a value for the gid also.
19812 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19813 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19814 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19815 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19816 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19817 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19821 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19822 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19823 before running the command.
19826 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19827 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19828 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19832 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19833 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19834 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19835 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19836 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19839 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19842 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19843 &%no_more%& is set.
19845 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19846 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19847 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19848 included in the SMTP response.
19850 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19851 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19852 included in any SMTP response.
19854 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19856 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19857 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19859 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19860 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19861 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19864 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19865 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19868 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19869 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19871 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19872 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19873 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19874 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19876 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19877 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19878 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19879 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19880 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19882 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19883 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19884 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19885 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19886 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19888 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19889 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19890 variable. For example, this return line
19892 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19894 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19895 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19896 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19897 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19902 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19903 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19905 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19906 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19907 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19908 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19909 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19910 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19911 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19912 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19913 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19914 redirected in several different ways:
19917 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19920 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19922 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19924 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19926 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19928 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19930 It can be discarded.
19933 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19934 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19935 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19936 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19938 If success DSNs have been requested
19939 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19940 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19941 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19945 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19946 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19947 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19948 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19949 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19950 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19954 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19956 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19957 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19958 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19959 cause delivery to be deferred.
19961 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19962 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19967 file = $home/.forward
19970 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19971 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19972 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19973 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19978 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19979 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19980 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19981 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19984 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19985 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19986 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19987 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19989 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19990 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19991 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19992 saves some resources.
20000 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20001 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20002 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20003 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20004 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20007 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20008 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20009 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20010 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20011 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20012 document is intended for use by end users.
20014 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20015 described in the next section.
20018 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
20019 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20020 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20021 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20022 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20026 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20027 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20028 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20029 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20030 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20031 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20032 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20033 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20034 commas or newlines.
20035 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20038 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20039 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20040 next newline character is ignored.
20042 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20043 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20044 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20045 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20048 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20049 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20050 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20051 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20052 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20053 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20056 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20060 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20061 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20062 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20063 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20064 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20065 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20066 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20067 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20068 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20069 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20070 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20072 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20073 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20074 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20075 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20076 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20078 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20080 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20081 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20082 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20083 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20084 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20087 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20088 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20089 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20090 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20091 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20093 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20094 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20099 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20100 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20103 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20105 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20106 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20107 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20108 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20109 should really contain
20111 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20113 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20114 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20115 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20119 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20120 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20121 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20124 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20125 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20126 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20127 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20128 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20129 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20130 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20132 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20133 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20134 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20135 in double quotes, for example:
20137 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20139 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20140 quote just the command. An item such as
20142 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20144 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20146 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20147 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20148 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20149 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20150 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20151 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20152 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20153 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20154 an &%accept%& router.
20157 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20158 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20159 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20160 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20162 /home/world/minbari
20164 is treated as a file name, but
20166 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20168 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20169 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20170 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20171 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20173 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20174 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20176 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20177 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20178 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20179 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20182 .cindex "included address list"
20183 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20184 If an item is of the form
20186 :include:<path name>
20188 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20189 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20190 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20191 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20192 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20193 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20195 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20197 It must be given as
20199 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20202 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20203 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20204 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20205 .cindex "black hole"
20206 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20207 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20208 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20209 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20213 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20214 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20215 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20217 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20218 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20219 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20220 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20224 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20225 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20226 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20227 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20228 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20229 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20230 redirection items of the form
20235 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20236 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20237 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20238 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20240 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20242 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20244 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20245 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20247 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20248 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20249 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20251 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20252 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20253 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20254 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20255 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20256 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20257 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20258 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20259 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20262 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20263 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20264 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20265 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20267 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20268 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20269 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20270 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20271 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20273 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20274 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20275 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20276 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20277 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20281 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20282 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20283 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20284 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20285 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20286 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20287 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20291 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20292 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20293 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20294 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20295 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20296 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20297 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20298 aliasing scheme of the type
20300 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20304 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20305 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20306 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20309 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20310 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20312 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20313 the pipes are distinct.
20317 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20318 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20319 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20320 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20321 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20322 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20323 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20324 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20325 can be used to avoid this.
20328 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20329 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20330 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20331 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20332 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20333 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20334 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20338 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20340 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20341 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20344 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20345 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20346 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20349 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20350 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20351 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20352 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20355 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20356 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20357 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20358 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20359 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20360 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20361 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20363 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20364 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20367 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20368 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20369 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20370 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20371 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20375 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20376 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20377 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20378 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20379 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20380 let ordinary users do.
20384 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20385 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20386 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20387 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20388 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20389 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20391 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20392 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20393 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20394 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20395 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20396 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20398 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20400 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20401 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20402 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20403 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20404 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20405 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20406 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20407 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20410 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20411 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20412 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20413 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20414 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20415 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20416 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20417 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20421 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20422 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20423 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20424 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20425 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20426 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20429 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20430 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20431 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20432 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20433 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20434 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20436 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20437 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20438 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20440 data = #Exim filter\n\
20441 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20443 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20444 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20445 choice into a newline.
20448 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20449 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20450 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20451 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20452 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20455 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20456 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20457 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20458 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20459 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20460 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20461 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20462 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20464 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20465 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20466 runs a check on the containing directory,
20467 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20468 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20469 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20470 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20471 not, the router declines.
20474 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20475 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20476 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20477 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20478 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20479 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20480 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20483 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20484 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20485 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20486 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20487 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20490 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20491 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20492 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20493 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20497 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20498 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20499 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20500 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20501 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20506 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20507 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20508 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20509 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20510 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20511 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20512 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20513 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20514 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20515 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20516 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20519 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20520 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20521 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20522 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20523 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20526 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20527 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20528 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20529 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20530 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20531 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20533 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20534 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20535 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20536 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20537 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20538 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20539 &_.forward_& files).
20542 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20543 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20544 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20545 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20546 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20549 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20550 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20551 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20552 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20553 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20554 of the embedded Perl support.
20557 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20558 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20559 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20560 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20561 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20564 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20565 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20566 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20567 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20568 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20571 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20572 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20573 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20574 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20575 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20576 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20577 &%one_time%& is set.
20580 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20581 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20582 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20583 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20584 to make use of &%run%& items.
20587 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20588 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20589 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20590 If this option is true, items of the form
20592 :include:<path name>
20594 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20597 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20598 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20599 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20600 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20601 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20602 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20603 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20606 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20607 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20608 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20609 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20610 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20613 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20614 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20615 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20616 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20617 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20622 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20623 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20624 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20625 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20626 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20627 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20628 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20631 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20633 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20634 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20635 file did not exist.
20638 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20640 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20641 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20642 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20644 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20645 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20646 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20647 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20648 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20649 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20650 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20651 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20655 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20656 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20657 redirection list must start with this directory.
20660 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20661 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20662 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20665 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20666 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20667 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20668 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20669 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20670 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20671 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20672 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20673 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20674 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20675 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20676 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20677 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20678 before they subscribed.
20680 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20681 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20682 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20683 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20686 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20687 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20688 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20689 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20691 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20692 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20693 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20695 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20698 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20699 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20700 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20701 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20702 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20706 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20707 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20708 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20709 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20710 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20711 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20712 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20713 See &%check_owner%& above.
20716 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20717 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20718 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20719 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20722 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20723 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20724 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20725 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20726 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20727 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20728 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20731 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20732 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20733 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20734 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20735 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20736 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20737 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20738 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20740 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20741 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20742 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20745 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20746 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20747 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20748 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20749 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20750 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20751 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20752 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20753 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20754 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20757 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20758 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20759 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20760 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20761 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20762 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20765 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20766 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20767 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20768 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20769 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20770 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20773 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20774 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20775 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20776 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20777 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20780 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20781 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20782 :subaddress part of an address.
20784 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20785 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20786 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20787 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20790 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20791 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20792 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20793 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20794 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20795 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20796 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20800 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20801 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20802 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20803 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20804 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20805 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20806 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20807 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20808 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20809 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20810 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20811 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20812 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20813 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20814 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20815 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20817 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20818 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20819 the following routers.
20821 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20822 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20823 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20824 so it is passed to the following routers.
20826 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20827 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20828 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20829 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20831 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20832 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20833 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20834 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20840 file = $home/.forward
20841 file_transport = address_file
20842 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20843 reply_transport = address_reply
20846 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20847 syntax_errors_text = \
20848 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20849 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20850 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20851 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20852 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20853 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20854 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20855 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20856 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20857 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20859 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20860 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20861 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20866 local_part_prefix = real-
20867 transport = local_delivery
20869 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20870 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20872 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20873 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20877 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20878 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20881 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20882 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20883 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20884 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20894 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20895 "Environment for local transports"
20896 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20897 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20898 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20899 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20900 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20901 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20902 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20904 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20905 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20906 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20907 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20909 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20910 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20911 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20912 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20913 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20917 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20918 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20919 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20920 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20921 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20922 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20923 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20926 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20927 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20931 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20933 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20934 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20935 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20936 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20941 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20942 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20943 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20944 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20945 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20946 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20947 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20948 group (set by the transport). For example:
20951 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20955 transport = group_delivery
20958 # This transport overrides the group
20960 driver = appendfile
20961 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20964 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20965 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20966 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20969 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20970 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20971 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20972 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20973 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20974 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20976 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20977 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20978 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20979 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20980 original gid is also used.
20982 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20983 following that is set is used:
20986 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20988 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20990 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20991 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20993 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20995 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20996 the uid is the creator's uid;
20998 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21001 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21002 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21003 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21004 The first of the following that is set is used:
21007 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21009 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21011 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21013 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21018 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21019 &%never_users%& list.
21025 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21026 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21027 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21028 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21029 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21030 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21031 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21032 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21033 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21034 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21037 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21039 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21041 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21043 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21046 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21049 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21051 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21055 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21056 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21057 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21061 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21062 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21063 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21064 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21065 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21066 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21067 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21068 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21069 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21070 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21071 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21072 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21073 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21074 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21083 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21085 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21086 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21087 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21088 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21089 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21092 .option body_only transports boolean false
21093 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21094 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21095 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21096 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21097 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21098 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21099 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21100 automatically suppress them.
21103 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21104 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21105 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21106 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21107 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21108 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21111 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21112 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21113 deliveries by the transport or for any
21114 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21115 what you are doing.
21118 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21119 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21120 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21121 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21123 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21124 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21125 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21126 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21127 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21128 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21130 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21131 transport and the router that called it.
21133 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21134 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21135 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21136 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21137 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21138 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21139 safely be resent to other recipients.
21142 .option driver transports string unset
21143 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21144 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21147 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21148 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21149 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21150 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21151 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21152 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21153 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21154 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21155 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21156 resent to other recipients.
21159 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21161 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21162 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21165 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21166 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21167 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21168 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21169 &%user%& (see below).
21172 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21173 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21174 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21175 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21176 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21177 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21178 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21179 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21180 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21181 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21182 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21184 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21185 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21188 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21189 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21190 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21191 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21192 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21193 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21194 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21195 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21198 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21199 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21200 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21201 This option specifies a list of header names,
21202 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21203 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21204 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21206 Each list item is separately expanded.
21207 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21208 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21209 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21211 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21212 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21214 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21215 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21216 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21220 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21221 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21222 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21223 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21224 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21225 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21226 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21227 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21230 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21233 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21234 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21235 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21236 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21237 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21238 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21239 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21240 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21241 change envelope recipients at this time.
21244 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21245 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21247 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21248 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21249 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21250 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21251 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21252 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21253 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21257 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21258 .cindex "additional groups"
21259 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21260 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21261 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21262 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21263 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21266 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21267 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21268 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21269 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21270 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21271 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21272 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21273 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21275 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21276 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21277 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21278 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21279 Obviously there is scope for
21280 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21281 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21283 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21284 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21285 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21286 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21287 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21290 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21291 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21292 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21293 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21294 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21295 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21296 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21297 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21298 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21299 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21300 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21301 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21302 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21307 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21308 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21309 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21310 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21311 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21312 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21313 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21314 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21317 local_part_prefix = *-
21319 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21322 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21324 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21325 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21326 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21327 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21328 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21331 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21332 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21333 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21334 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21335 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21336 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21337 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21338 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21339 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21341 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21342 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21343 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21344 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21346 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21347 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21348 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21351 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21352 .cindex "envelope sender"
21353 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21354 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21355 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21356 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21357 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21358 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21359 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21360 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21361 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21363 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21364 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21366 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21367 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21368 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21369 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21370 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21371 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21372 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21374 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21375 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21376 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21377 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21378 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21382 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21383 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21384 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21385 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21386 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21387 have easy access to it.
21389 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21390 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21391 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21392 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21393 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21397 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21398 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21401 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21402 .cindex "shadow transport"
21403 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21404 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21405 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21407 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21408 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21409 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21410 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21411 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21412 cause a log line to be written.
21414 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21415 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21416 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21417 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21418 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21421 ST=<shadow transport name>
21423 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21424 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21425 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21426 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21427 headers that some sites insist on.
21430 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21431 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21432 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21433 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21434 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21435 individual users or via a system filter.
21436 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21438 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21439 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21440 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21441 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21442 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21444 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21445 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21446 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21447 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21448 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21449 &(pipe)& transports.
21451 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21452 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21453 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21454 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21455 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21457 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21458 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21459 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21460 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21462 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21463 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21464 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21465 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21466 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21467 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21469 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21470 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21471 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21472 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21473 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21474 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21475 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21476 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21478 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21479 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21480 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21481 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21482 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21483 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21484 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21485 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21486 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21487 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21490 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21491 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21492 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21493 which the message is being sent. For example:
21495 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21496 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21499 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21500 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21501 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21503 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21504 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21505 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21508 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21510 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21511 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21512 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21513 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21514 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21515 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21517 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21518 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21519 arguments. Consider this example:
21521 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21522 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21524 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21525 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21527 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21528 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21532 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21533 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21534 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21535 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21536 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21537 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21538 bounced from a transport filter.
21540 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21541 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21542 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21545 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21546 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21547 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21548 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21549 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21550 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21551 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21552 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21553 becomes a temporary error.
21556 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21557 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21558 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21559 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21560 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21561 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21562 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21565 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21566 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21567 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21569 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21570 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21571 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21572 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21574 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21575 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21576 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21583 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21584 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21586 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21588 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21589 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21590 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21591 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21592 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21593 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21594 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21596 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21597 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21598 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21599 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21600 local transport, for example:
21603 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21604 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21605 recipients saves space.
21607 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21608 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21610 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21611 to a scanner program or
21612 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21616 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21617 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21618 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21620 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21621 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21622 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21623 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21624 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21625 to certain conditions:
21628 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21629 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21630 batching is possible.
21632 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21633 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21634 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21636 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21637 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21638 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21639 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21640 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21643 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21644 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21645 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21649 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21650 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21651 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21652 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21653 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21654 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21655 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21658 escape_string = ".."
21660 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21661 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21662 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21664 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21665 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21666 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21667 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21668 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21669 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21671 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21672 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21673 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21674 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21675 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21676 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21677 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21678 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21679 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21687 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21688 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21689 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21690 .cindex "directory creation"
21691 .cindex "creating directories"
21692 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21693 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21694 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21695 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21696 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21697 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21698 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21699 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21700 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21701 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21703 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21704 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21705 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21708 .cindex "quota" "system"
21709 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21710 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21711 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21713 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21714 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21715 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21716 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21718 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21719 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21722 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21723 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21724 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21725 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21730 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21731 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21732 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21733 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21734 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21736 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21737 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21738 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21739 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21740 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21741 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21742 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21743 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21744 operation. There are two cases:
21747 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21748 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21749 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21750 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21751 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21752 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21753 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21755 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21756 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21757 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21761 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21762 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21763 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21764 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21769 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21771 require "fileinto";
21772 fileinto "folder23";
21774 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21775 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21776 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21777 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21778 way of handling this requirement:
21780 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21781 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21782 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21784 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21788 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21789 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21790 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21792 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21793 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21794 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21795 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21796 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21797 path to the transport.
21799 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21800 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21805 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21806 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21810 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21811 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21812 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21813 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21814 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21815 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21816 delivery is deferred.
21819 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21820 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21821 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21822 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21823 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21824 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21825 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21826 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21829 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21830 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21831 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21832 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21836 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21837 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21840 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21841 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21842 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21843 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21844 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21847 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21848 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21849 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21850 process is running.
21853 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21854 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21855 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21856 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21857 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21858 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21859 contains is significant.
21861 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21862 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21863 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21864 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21865 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21867 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21868 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21869 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21870 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21871 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21872 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21874 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21875 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21876 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21877 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21879 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21880 .cindex "directory creation"
21881 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21882 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21883 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21885 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21886 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21887 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21888 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21889 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21893 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21894 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21895 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21896 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21897 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21900 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21901 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21902 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21903 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21904 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21905 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21906 &%file_must_exist%&.
21909 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21910 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21911 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21912 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21914 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21915 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21916 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21917 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21918 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21921 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21923 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21924 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21925 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21926 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21928 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21930 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21931 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21935 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21936 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21937 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21940 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21941 See &%check_string%& above.
21944 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21945 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21946 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21947 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21948 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21949 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21952 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21953 .cindex "locking files"
21954 .cindex "lock files"
21955 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21956 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21958 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21959 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21962 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21963 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21966 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21967 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21968 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21969 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21970 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21971 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21975 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21976 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21977 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21978 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21979 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21980 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21981 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21982 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21983 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21986 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21987 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21989 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21990 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21991 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21992 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21993 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21994 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21995 delivery is deferred.
21998 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21999 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22000 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22001 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22004 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22005 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22006 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22007 .cindex "locking files"
22008 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22009 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22010 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22011 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22012 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22013 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22014 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22015 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22017 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22018 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22019 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22020 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22022 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22023 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22026 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22028 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22029 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22030 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22032 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22033 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22035 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22038 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22039 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22040 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22041 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22044 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22045 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22046 for details of locking.
22049 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22050 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22051 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22054 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22055 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22056 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22059 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22060 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22061 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22062 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22063 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22066 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22067 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22068 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22069 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22070 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22071 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22072 external source that maintains the data.
22075 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22076 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22077 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22078 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22079 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22080 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22081 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22082 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22086 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22087 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22088 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22089 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22090 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22091 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22092 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22093 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22094 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22095 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22098 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22099 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22100 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22101 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22102 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22103 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22104 calculation. The default value is:
22106 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22108 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22109 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22111 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22113 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22115 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22116 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22117 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22118 directly into that directory.
22121 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22122 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22123 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22126 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22127 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22128 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22131 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22132 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22133 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22134 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22135 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22136 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22137 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22138 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22140 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22141 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22142 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22143 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22144 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22145 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22146 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22147 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22148 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22149 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22152 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22153 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22154 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22155 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22156 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22157 below for further details.
22160 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22161 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22162 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22165 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22166 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22167 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22170 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22171 .cindex "locking files"
22172 .cindex "file" "locking"
22173 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22174 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22175 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22176 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22177 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22178 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22179 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22181 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22182 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22183 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22190 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22191 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22192 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22193 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22194 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22195 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22196 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22197 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22199 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22200 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22201 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22202 append messages to it.
22205 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22206 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22207 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22208 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22209 in which case it is:
22211 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22212 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22214 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22215 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22217 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22218 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22219 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22220 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22225 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22226 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22228 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22229 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22230 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22231 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22232 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22233 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22234 value, and this option is ignored.
22237 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22238 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22239 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22240 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22241 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22244 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22245 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22246 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22247 on users about incoming mail.
22250 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22251 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22252 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22253 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22254 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22255 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22256 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22257 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22258 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22260 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22261 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22262 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22264 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22265 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22266 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22267 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22268 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22269 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22271 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22272 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22273 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22274 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22275 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22278 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22279 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22281 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22283 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22284 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22285 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22286 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22287 system quota failures.
22289 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22290 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22291 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22292 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22293 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22294 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22295 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22296 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22297 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22298 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22301 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22302 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22303 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22304 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22305 delivery directory.
22308 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22309 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22310 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22311 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22312 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22315 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22316 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22318 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22319 See &%quota%& above.
22322 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22323 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22324 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22325 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22326 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22327 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22328 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22330 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22331 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22332 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22333 the file length to the file name. For example:
22335 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22336 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22338 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22339 number of lines in the message.
22341 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22342 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22343 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22345 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22348 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22349 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22350 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22352 quota_warn_message = "\
22353 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22354 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22355 This message is automatically created \
22356 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22357 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22358 a warning threshold that is\n\
22359 set by the system administrator.\n"
22363 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22364 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22365 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22366 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22367 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22368 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22369 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22370 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22371 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22375 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22377 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22378 percent sign is ignored.
22380 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22381 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22382 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22383 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22384 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22385 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22387 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22389 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22390 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22393 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22394 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22398 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22399 .cindex "envelope sender"
22400 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22401 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22402 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22403 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22404 for details of batch SMTP.
22407 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22408 .cindex "carriage return"
22410 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22411 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22412 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22413 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22415 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22416 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22417 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22418 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22419 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22420 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22423 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22424 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22425 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22426 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22427 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22428 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22431 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22432 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22433 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22434 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22435 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22437 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22438 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22439 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22440 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22442 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22443 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22444 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22445 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22446 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22449 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22450 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22453 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22454 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22455 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22456 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22457 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22458 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22459 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22461 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22462 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22463 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22464 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22467 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22468 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22469 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22472 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22473 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22474 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22475 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22476 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22477 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22478 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22479 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22480 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22482 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22483 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22484 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22485 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22490 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22491 .cindex "appending to a file"
22492 .cindex "file" "appending"
22493 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22496 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22500 .cindex "directory creation"
22501 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22502 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22503 &%directory_mode%& option.
22506 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22507 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22511 .cindex "file" "locking"
22512 .cindex "locking files"
22513 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22514 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22515 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22518 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22519 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22520 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22522 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22524 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22525 Unlink the hitching post name.
22527 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22528 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22529 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22530 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22532 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22533 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22534 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22535 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22536 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22537 it before trying again.
22541 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22542 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22543 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22546 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22547 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22548 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22549 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22550 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22551 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22552 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22553 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22554 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22558 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22559 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22560 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22561 delivery is deferred.
22564 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22565 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22566 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22570 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22571 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22572 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22575 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22576 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22577 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22580 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22581 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22582 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22583 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22584 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22585 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22586 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22587 that prevents link following.
22590 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22591 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22592 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22593 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22594 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22597 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22600 .cindex "file" "locking"
22601 .cindex "locking files"
22602 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22603 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22604 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22605 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22606 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22608 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22610 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22611 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22612 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22614 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22615 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22616 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22618 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22619 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22620 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22621 delivery is deferred.
22623 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22624 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22625 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22626 immediately. It retries up to
22628 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22630 times (rounded up).
22633 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22634 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22637 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22638 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22639 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22640 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22641 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22642 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22643 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22644 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22645 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22646 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22648 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22649 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22650 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22651 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22652 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22653 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22654 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22656 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22657 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22658 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22659 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22662 .cindex "maildir format"
22663 .cindex "mailstore format"
22664 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22665 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22666 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22667 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22668 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22670 .cindex "directory creation"
22671 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22672 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22673 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22674 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22675 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22676 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22681 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22682 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22683 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22684 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22685 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22686 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22687 &_new_& subdirectory.
22689 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22690 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22691 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22692 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22693 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22694 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22695 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22697 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22698 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22699 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22700 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22701 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22702 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22703 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22704 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22706 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22707 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22708 folders. Consider this example:
22710 maildir_format = true
22711 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22712 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22713 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22714 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22716 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22717 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22718 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22719 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22720 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22721 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22723 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22724 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22725 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22726 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22727 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22729 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22730 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22731 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22733 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22734 .cindex "maildir++"
22735 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22736 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22737 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22738 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22739 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22740 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22741 amount of space used.
22743 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22744 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22745 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22746 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22747 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22748 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22753 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22754 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22755 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22756 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22757 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22758 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22761 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22762 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22763 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22764 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22765 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22766 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22767 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22768 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22769 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22770 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22771 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22772 backwards compatibility).
22774 For one common implementation, you might set:
22776 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22778 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22780 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22781 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22782 &[stat()]& each message file.
22785 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22786 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22787 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22788 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22789 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22790 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22791 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22792 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22793 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22795 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22796 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22797 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22798 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22799 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22800 need to know the quota.
22802 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22803 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22805 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22806 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22807 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22811 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22812 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22813 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22814 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22815 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22816 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22817 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22818 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22820 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22821 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22822 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22823 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22824 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22825 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22827 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22828 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22829 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22830 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22831 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22832 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22834 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22835 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22836 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22837 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22840 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22841 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22842 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22843 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22844 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22846 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22848 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22849 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22850 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22851 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22852 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22862 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22863 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22864 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22865 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22866 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22867 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22868 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22869 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22871 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22872 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22873 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22874 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22875 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22878 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22879 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22880 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22881 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22882 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22884 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22885 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22886 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22887 transport is run as a consequence of a
22889 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22890 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22891 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22892 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22893 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22894 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22896 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22897 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22898 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22899 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22901 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22902 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22903 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22904 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22905 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22906 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22907 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22909 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22910 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22911 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22912 the transport defers.
22913 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22914 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22916 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22917 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22918 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22919 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22921 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22922 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22923 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22924 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22925 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22926 problems. They are just discarded.
22930 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22931 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22933 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22934 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22935 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22938 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22939 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22940 when the message is specified by the transport.
22943 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22944 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22945 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22946 string comes first.
22949 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22950 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22951 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22954 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22955 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22956 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22959 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22960 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22961 specified by the transport.
22964 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22965 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22966 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22967 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22970 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22971 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22972 the message is specified by the transport.
22975 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22976 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22980 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22981 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22982 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22983 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22984 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22988 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22989 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22990 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22991 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22993 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22994 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22995 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22996 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22997 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22998 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22999 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23002 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23003 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23004 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23005 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23006 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23008 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23009 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23010 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23011 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23012 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23013 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23016 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23017 See &%once%& above.
23020 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23021 See &%once%& above.
23022 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23025 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23026 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23027 specified by the transport.
23030 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23031 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23032 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23033 configuration option.
23036 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23037 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23038 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23039 automatic responses. For example:
23041 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23043 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23044 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23045 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23046 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23051 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23052 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23053 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23054 the text comes first.
23057 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23058 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23059 when the message is specified by the transport.
23060 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23061 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23066 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23067 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23069 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23070 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23071 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23072 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23073 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23074 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23076 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23077 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23078 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23079 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23080 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23081 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23085 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23086 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23087 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23090 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23091 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23094 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23095 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23096 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23097 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23098 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23101 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23102 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23103 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23104 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23105 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23106 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23109 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23110 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23111 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23112 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23113 in its response to the LHLO command.
23115 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23116 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23117 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23118 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23121 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23122 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23123 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23124 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23129 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23133 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23134 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23138 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23139 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23141 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23142 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23143 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23144 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23145 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23146 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23147 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23148 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23152 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23153 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23154 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23155 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23156 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23158 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23159 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23160 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23161 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23162 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23163 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23164 that are routed to the transport.
23166 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23167 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23168 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23169 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23170 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23171 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23172 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23176 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23177 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23178 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23180 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23181 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23182 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23183 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23184 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23185 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23186 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23189 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23190 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23191 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23192 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23193 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23194 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23195 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23200 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23201 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23202 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23203 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23204 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23205 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23206 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23207 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23208 &"local delivery failed"&.
23210 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23211 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23212 will be sent as normal.
23214 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23215 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23216 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23217 apply in this case.
23219 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23220 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23221 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23222 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23224 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23225 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23226 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23227 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23228 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23229 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23230 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23235 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23236 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23237 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23238 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23239 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23242 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23243 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23244 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23245 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23247 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23248 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23249 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23250 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23251 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23253 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23255 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23256 arguments. You have to write
23258 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23260 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23261 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23262 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23263 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23264 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23265 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23268 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23271 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23272 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23273 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23274 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23275 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23276 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23277 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23278 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23279 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23280 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23282 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23283 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23284 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23285 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23286 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23287 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23288 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23289 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23291 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23292 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23293 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23294 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23295 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23296 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23297 control what is done with it.
23299 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23300 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23301 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23302 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23303 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23304 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23305 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23306 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23307 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23308 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23309 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23313 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23314 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23315 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23316 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23317 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23318 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23319 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23320 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23322 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23323 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23324 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23325 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23326 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23327 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23328 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23329 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23330 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23331 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23332 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23333 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23334 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23335 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23336 &`USER `& see below
23338 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23339 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23340 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23341 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23342 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23343 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23344 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23347 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23348 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23349 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23353 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23354 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23355 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23356 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23359 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23360 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23364 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23365 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23366 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23367 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23368 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23369 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23370 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23371 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23372 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23373 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23374 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23377 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23379 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23380 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23381 &%use_shell%& is set.
23384 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23385 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23388 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23389 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23390 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23393 .option check_string pipe string unset
23394 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23395 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23396 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23397 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23398 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23399 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23400 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23404 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23405 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23406 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23407 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23408 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23409 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23410 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23413 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23414 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23415 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23416 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23417 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23418 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23419 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23422 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23423 See &%check_string%& above.
23426 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23427 .cindex "exec failure"
23428 .cindex "failure of exec"
23429 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23430 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23431 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23432 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23433 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23436 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23437 .cindex "signal exit"
23438 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23439 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23440 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23441 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23444 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23445 .cindex "force command"
23446 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23447 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23448 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23449 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23450 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23451 command. For example:
23453 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23457 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23458 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23459 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23462 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23463 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23464 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23465 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23466 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23467 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23469 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23470 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23473 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23474 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23475 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23476 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23477 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23478 written to the main log.
23481 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23482 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23483 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23484 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23485 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23486 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23490 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23491 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23492 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23493 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23494 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23497 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23498 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23499 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23500 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23501 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23502 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23503 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23504 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23507 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23508 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23509 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23512 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23516 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23517 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23518 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23519 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23520 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23525 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23526 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23529 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23530 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23531 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23532 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23536 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23537 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23540 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23541 This option is expanded and
23542 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23543 variable of the subprocess.
23544 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23545 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23546 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23549 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23550 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23551 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23552 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23553 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23554 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23555 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23556 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23557 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23560 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23561 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23562 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23563 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23564 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23565 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23566 accept the message is used.
23569 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23570 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23571 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23572 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23573 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23574 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23577 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23578 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23579 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23580 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23581 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23582 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23583 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23587 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23588 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23589 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23590 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23591 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23592 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23593 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23594 of them may be set.
23598 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23599 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23600 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23601 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23602 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23603 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23604 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23605 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23606 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23607 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23608 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23609 and 73, respectively.
23612 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23613 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23614 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23615 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23616 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23617 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23618 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23620 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23621 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23622 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23623 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23624 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23625 delivery to be deferred.
23627 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23628 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23631 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23632 .cindex "envelope sender"
23633 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23634 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23635 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23636 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23637 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23639 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23640 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23641 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23642 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23643 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23644 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23648 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23649 .cindex "carriage return"
23651 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23652 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23653 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23654 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23656 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23657 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23658 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23659 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23660 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23663 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23664 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23665 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23666 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23667 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23668 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23669 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23670 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23671 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23676 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23677 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23678 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23679 .cindex "external local delivery"
23680 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23681 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23682 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23683 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23684 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23685 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23686 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23687 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23688 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23689 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23694 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23698 check_string = "From "
23699 escape_string = ">From "
23708 transport = procmail_pipe
23710 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23711 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23712 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23713 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23714 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23715 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23717 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23721 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23722 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23725 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23726 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23729 local_delivery_cyrus:
23731 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23732 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23744 local_part_suffix = .*
23745 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23747 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23748 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23750 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23751 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23754 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23755 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23757 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23758 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23759 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23760 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23761 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23762 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23763 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23764 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23767 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23768 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23772 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23773 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23774 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23775 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23776 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23777 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23778 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23780 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23781 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23782 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23783 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23784 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23785 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23790 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23791 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23792 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23796 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23798 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23799 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23800 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23801 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23802 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23803 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23804 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23805 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23808 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23809 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23810 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23811 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23812 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23813 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23814 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23815 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23816 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23817 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23818 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23819 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23820 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23821 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23823 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23824 and will be removed in a future release.
23827 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23828 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23829 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23832 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23833 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23834 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23835 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23836 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23837 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23838 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23839 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23841 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23842 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23843 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23844 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23845 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23846 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23847 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23848 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23849 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23852 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23854 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23855 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23856 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23857 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23858 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23861 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23862 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23863 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23864 particular connection.
23866 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23867 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23868 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23869 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23871 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23872 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23873 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23875 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23877 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23878 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23880 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23881 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23885 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23886 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23887 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23888 authenticated as a client.
23891 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23892 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23893 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23894 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23897 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23898 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23899 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23900 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23901 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23902 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23903 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23906 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23907 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23908 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23909 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23910 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23911 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23912 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23916 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23917 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23918 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23919 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23922 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23923 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23924 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23925 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23926 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23927 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
23928 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
23929 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
23930 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23933 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23934 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23935 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23938 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23939 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23940 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23941 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23942 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23943 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23945 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23946 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23947 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23948 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23949 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23950 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23951 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23952 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23956 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23957 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23958 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23959 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23960 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23963 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23964 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23965 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23966 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23970 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23971 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23972 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23973 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23974 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23975 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23976 the dnssec request bit set.
23977 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23981 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23982 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23983 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23984 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23985 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23986 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
23987 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23988 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23989 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23993 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23994 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23995 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23996 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23997 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23998 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23999 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24001 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24002 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24003 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24004 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24005 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24008 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24009 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24010 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24011 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24012 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24013 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24014 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24015 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24017 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24018 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24019 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24020 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24021 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24022 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24024 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24025 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24026 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24027 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24028 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24030 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24031 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24032 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24033 copy of the message is sent.
24035 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24036 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24037 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24038 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24042 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24043 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24044 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24047 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24048 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24049 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24050 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24051 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24052 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24054 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24055 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24056 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24057 implementations of TLS.
24059 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24060 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24061 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24062 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24063 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24064 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24065 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24070 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24071 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24072 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24073 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24074 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24075 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24076 interface address, you could use this:
24078 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24079 {$primary_hostname}}
24081 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24084 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24085 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24086 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24087 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24088 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24089 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24091 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24092 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24093 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24094 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24096 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24097 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24098 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24099 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24100 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24101 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24102 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24104 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24105 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24106 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24107 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24108 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24109 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24110 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24113 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24114 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24117 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24118 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24119 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24120 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24121 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24122 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24123 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24124 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24125 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24126 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24129 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24130 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24131 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24132 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24135 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24136 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24137 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24138 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24140 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24141 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24142 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24143 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24144 to any host that matches this list.
24147 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24148 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24149 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24150 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24151 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24152 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24153 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24154 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24157 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24158 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24159 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24164 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24165 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24166 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24167 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24168 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24169 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24170 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24171 explanation of when this might be needed.
24173 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24174 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24175 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24176 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24177 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24178 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24179 message on the same session.
24181 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24182 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24183 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24184 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24185 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24186 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24191 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24192 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24193 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24194 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24195 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24198 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24199 .cindex "randomized host list"
24200 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24201 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24202 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24203 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24204 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24205 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24206 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24207 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24209 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24210 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24211 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24212 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24214 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24216 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24217 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24218 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24220 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24221 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24222 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24223 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24224 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24225 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24226 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24227 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24228 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24231 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24232 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24233 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24234 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24235 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24238 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24239 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24240 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24241 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24242 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24243 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24244 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24245 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24248 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24249 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24250 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24251 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24252 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24254 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24255 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24256 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24257 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24258 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24259 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24261 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24262 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24263 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24264 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24265 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24266 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24267 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24269 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24270 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24271 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24272 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24273 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24274 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24275 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24278 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24279 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24280 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24281 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24282 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24283 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24284 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24285 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24286 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24289 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24290 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24291 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24292 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24293 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24294 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24295 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24296 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24297 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24298 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24300 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24301 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24303 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24304 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24305 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24306 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24307 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24309 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24310 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24311 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24312 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24313 for multi-recipient messages.
24314 The option can usually be left as default.
24316 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24317 .cindex "bind IP address"
24318 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24320 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24321 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24322 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24323 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24324 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24325 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24326 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24327 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24330 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24331 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24332 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24333 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24334 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24335 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24337 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24339 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24340 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24341 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24342 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24345 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24346 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24347 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24348 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24349 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24350 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24351 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24352 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24353 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24354 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24358 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24359 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24360 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24361 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24362 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24364 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24365 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24366 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24367 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24368 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24372 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24373 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24374 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24375 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24376 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24377 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24378 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24379 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24381 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24382 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24383 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24385 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24386 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24387 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24388 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24389 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24390 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24391 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24392 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24394 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24395 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24396 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24397 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24402 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24403 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24404 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24405 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24407 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24408 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24409 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24410 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24411 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24413 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24414 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24415 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24416 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24419 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24420 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24421 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24422 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24423 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24424 addresses is not affected.
24426 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24427 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24428 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24429 Exim to use only the host name.
24430 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24433 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24434 .cindex "serializing connections"
24435 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24436 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24437 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24438 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24439 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24440 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24441 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24443 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24444 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24445 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24446 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24447 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24448 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24450 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24451 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24452 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24453 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24454 are used for ETRN serialization.
24456 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24459 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24460 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24461 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24462 .cindex "size" "of message"
24463 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24464 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24465 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24466 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24467 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24468 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24469 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24470 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24472 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24473 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24476 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24477 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24478 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24479 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24482 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24483 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24484 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24486 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24487 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24488 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24489 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24490 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24493 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24494 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24495 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24496 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24500 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24501 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24502 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24503 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24504 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24507 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24508 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24509 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24510 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24511 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24512 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24515 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24518 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24519 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24521 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24522 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24523 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24524 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24525 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24526 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24527 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24528 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24531 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24532 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24533 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24535 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24536 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24537 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24538 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24539 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24540 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24541 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24542 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24543 ciphers is a preference order.
24547 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24548 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24549 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24550 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24551 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24552 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24553 certificate and private key for the session.
24555 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24557 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24563 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24564 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24565 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24566 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24567 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24568 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24569 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24570 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24571 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24572 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24576 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24577 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24578 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24579 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24580 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24581 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24582 Note that unless the host is in this list
24583 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24584 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24585 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24586 certificate verification succeeds.
24589 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24590 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24591 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24592 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24593 while verifying the server certificate,
24594 checks will be included on the host name
24595 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24596 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24597 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24599 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24602 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24603 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24604 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24606 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24607 The value of this option must be either the
24609 or the absolute path to
24610 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24611 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24613 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24614 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24615 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24618 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24619 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24621 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24623 either by file or directory
24624 are added to those given by the system default location.
24626 The values of &$host$& and
24627 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24628 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24630 For back-compatibility,
24631 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24632 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24633 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24636 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24637 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24638 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24639 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24640 certificate verification must succeed.
24641 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24642 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24643 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24648 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24650 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24651 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24652 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24653 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24654 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24657 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24658 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24659 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24660 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24663 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24664 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24665 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24667 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24668 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24669 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24670 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24671 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24673 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24674 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24675 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24676 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24677 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24678 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24679 see below for an exception).
24681 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24682 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24683 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24684 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24685 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24687 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24688 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24689 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24690 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24691 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24692 reached their retry times.
24694 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24695 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24696 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24697 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24698 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24699 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24700 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24701 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24702 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24703 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24706 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24707 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24708 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24709 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24710 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24711 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24713 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24714 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24715 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24716 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24717 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24718 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24724 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24725 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24727 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24728 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24729 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24730 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24731 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24732 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24734 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24735 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24736 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24737 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24738 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24739 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24740 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24742 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24743 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24744 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24745 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24748 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24749 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24750 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24751 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24753 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24754 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24755 facility; you do not have to use it.
24757 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24758 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24759 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24760 address to which it applies.
24762 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24763 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24764 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24765 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24766 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24767 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24770 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24771 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24772 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24773 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24776 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24777 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24778 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24779 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24780 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24783 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24784 illustrated by these examples:
24787 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24788 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24789 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24790 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24792 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24793 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24798 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24799 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24800 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24801 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24802 message's processing.
24804 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24805 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24806 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24807 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24808 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24809 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24810 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24811 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24812 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24814 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24815 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24816 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24817 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24818 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24819 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24820 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24821 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24822 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24823 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24825 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24826 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24827 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24828 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24829 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24830 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24832 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24833 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24834 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24836 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24837 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24838 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24839 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24840 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24841 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24842 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24843 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24844 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24846 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24847 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24853 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24854 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24855 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24856 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24857 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24858 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24859 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24860 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24861 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24862 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24864 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24866 might produce the output
24868 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24869 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24870 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24871 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24872 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24873 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24874 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24875 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24877 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24878 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24879 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24880 set for a particular transport.
24883 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24884 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24885 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24888 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24890 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24891 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24892 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24893 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24895 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24896 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24897 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24898 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24901 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24902 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24903 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24905 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24906 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24907 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24908 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24909 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24910 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24911 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24913 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24914 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24915 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24916 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24917 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24921 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24922 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24925 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24926 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24927 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24928 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24929 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24930 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24931 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24932 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24933 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24935 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24936 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24937 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24939 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24940 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24941 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24942 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24943 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24944 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24945 of pattern they are set as follows:
24948 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24949 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24950 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24953 *queen@*.fict.example
24955 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24957 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24961 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24962 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24965 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24966 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24967 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24968 rewriting rule of the form
24970 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24972 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24978 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24979 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24980 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24981 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24982 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24986 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24987 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24988 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24989 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24990 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24992 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24994 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24997 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24998 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24999 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25000 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25001 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25002 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25003 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25004 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25005 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25006 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25007 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25008 entry written to the panic log.
25012 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25013 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25016 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25019 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25021 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25024 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25025 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25029 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25031 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25032 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25033 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25034 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25035 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25036 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25038 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25039 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25040 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25041 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25042 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25043 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25044 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25045 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25046 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25047 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25049 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25050 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25051 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25053 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25054 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25057 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25058 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25059 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25060 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25061 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25062 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25063 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25064 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25065 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25067 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25068 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25069 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25070 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25071 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25072 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25073 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25074 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25077 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25078 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25079 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25080 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25083 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25084 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25085 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25087 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25088 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25089 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25090 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25092 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25093 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25094 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25096 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25097 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25098 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25099 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25101 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25105 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25108 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25109 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25110 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25111 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25112 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25113 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25114 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25115 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25117 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25118 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25122 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25123 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25125 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25126 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25127 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25129 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25130 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25131 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25132 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25133 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25134 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25135 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25136 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25138 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25139 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25141 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25143 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25144 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25146 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25147 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25148 messages that originate outside the local host:
25150 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25151 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25153 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25156 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25157 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25158 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25159 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25160 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25161 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25162 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25163 components. For example, the rule
25165 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25167 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25168 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25169 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25170 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25171 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25172 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25173 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25181 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25183 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25184 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25185 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25186 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25187 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25188 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25189 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25190 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25191 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25192 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25193 address, domain and error.
25195 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25196 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25197 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25198 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25199 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25200 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25201 log selector is set, the message
25202 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25203 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25204 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25205 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25207 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25208 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25209 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25210 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25211 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25212 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25213 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25214 domain are maintained independently.
25216 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25217 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25218 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25219 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25220 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25221 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25222 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25223 the local address is reached.
25225 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25226 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25227 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25228 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25229 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25231 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25232 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25233 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25234 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25235 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25236 messages that it should now be retaining.
25240 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25241 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25242 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25243 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25244 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25245 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25246 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25247 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25248 message's sender, respectively.
25251 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25252 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25253 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25254 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25255 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25256 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25259 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25261 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25264 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25266 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25267 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25270 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25271 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25272 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25273 expressions work in address lists.
25275 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25276 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25280 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25281 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25282 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25283 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25284 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25285 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25286 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25287 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25288 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25290 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25291 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25292 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25293 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25296 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25297 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25298 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25299 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25300 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25301 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25302 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25303 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25304 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25305 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25310 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25312 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25313 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25314 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25315 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25316 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25317 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25319 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25323 and the retry rules are
25325 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25326 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25328 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25329 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25330 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25331 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25332 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25333 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25335 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25336 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25337 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25338 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25340 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25341 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25342 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25344 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25346 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25347 textual form of the IP address.
25349 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25350 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25351 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25352 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25355 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25356 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25357 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25359 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25360 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25361 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25363 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25364 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25366 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25367 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25370 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25371 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25372 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25373 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25374 retry rule of this form:
25376 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25378 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25379 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25382 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25383 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25384 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25385 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25388 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25389 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25390 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25391 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25392 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25394 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25395 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25397 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25398 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25401 A connection was refused.
25403 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25404 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25406 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25407 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25409 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25410 A connection attempt timed out.
25412 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25413 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25414 obtained from an MX record.
25416 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25417 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25418 obtained from an MX record.
25421 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25423 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25424 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25425 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25426 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25429 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25432 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25433 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25434 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25435 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25436 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25437 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25441 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25442 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25443 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25444 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25445 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25449 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25450 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25451 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25453 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25454 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25455 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25456 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25457 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25458 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25459 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25461 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25462 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25465 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25466 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25467 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25472 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25473 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25474 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25475 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25476 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25479 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25481 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25483 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25485 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25486 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25489 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25491 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25492 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25493 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25494 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25495 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25497 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25498 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25500 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25502 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25503 list is never matched.
25509 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25510 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25511 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25512 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25514 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25516 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25517 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25518 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25519 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25520 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25522 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25523 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25524 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25525 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25526 The available algorithms are:
25529 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25532 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25533 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25534 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25536 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25537 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25538 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25539 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25540 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25541 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25542 queue processing times.
25545 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25546 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25547 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25548 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25549 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25550 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25551 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25552 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25553 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25554 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25555 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25556 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25558 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25559 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25560 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25561 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25562 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25563 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25566 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25567 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25568 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25569 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25570 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25571 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25572 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25573 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25574 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25575 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25576 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25577 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25579 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25580 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25581 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25582 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25583 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25584 deliveries that have been deferred.
25587 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25588 Here are some example retry rules:
25590 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25591 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25592 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25593 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25594 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25595 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25597 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25598 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25599 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25600 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25601 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25602 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25603 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25606 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25607 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25608 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25609 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25610 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25612 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25613 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25614 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25615 were not obtained from an MX record.
25617 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25618 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25619 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25620 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25621 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25625 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25626 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25627 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25628 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25629 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25630 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25631 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25632 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25633 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25634 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25635 failing for the first time.
25637 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25638 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25639 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25640 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25642 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25643 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25644 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25649 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25650 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25651 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25652 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25653 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25654 default retry rule:
25656 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25658 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25659 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25660 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25662 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25663 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25664 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25665 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25666 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25668 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25669 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25670 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25672 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25673 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25674 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25675 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25676 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25677 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25678 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25679 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25681 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25682 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25683 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25684 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25685 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25688 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25689 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25690 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25691 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25692 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25693 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25694 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25695 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25696 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25699 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25700 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25701 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25702 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25703 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25704 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25705 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25706 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25709 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25710 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25711 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25712 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25713 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25714 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25715 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25716 time out the address.
25718 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25719 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25720 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25721 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25722 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25723 considered immediately.
25724 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25725 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25735 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25736 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25737 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25738 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25739 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25740 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25741 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25742 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25743 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25746 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25747 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25750 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25751 the client's EHLO command.
25753 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25754 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25756 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25757 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25758 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25759 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25760 with the AUTH command.
25762 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25764 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25765 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25766 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25769 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25770 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25771 unauthenticated connection.
25774 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25775 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25776 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25777 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25779 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25780 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25781 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25782 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
25783 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25784 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25785 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25786 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25791 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25792 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25793 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25794 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25795 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25796 included by setting
25799 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25802 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25807 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25808 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25809 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25810 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25811 work via a socket interface.
25812 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25813 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25814 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25815 supporting setting a server keytab.
25816 The sixth can be configured to support
25817 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25818 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25819 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25820 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25821 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25823 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25824 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25825 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25826 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25827 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25828 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25829 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25831 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25832 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25833 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25834 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25835 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25836 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25840 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25841 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25843 client_secret = secret2
25845 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25846 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25848 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25849 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25850 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25853 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25854 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25855 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25856 authenticating data.
25858 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25859 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25860 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25861 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25862 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25863 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25864 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25865 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25866 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25867 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25870 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25871 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25872 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25873 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25877 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25878 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25879 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25881 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25882 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25883 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25884 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25885 encrypted by a setting such as:
25887 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25891 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25892 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25893 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25894 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25897 .option driver authenticators string unset
25898 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25899 authenticators is to be used.
25902 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25903 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25904 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25905 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25906 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25907 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25910 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25911 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25912 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25913 mechanism is not advertised.
25914 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25915 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25916 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25919 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25920 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25921 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25924 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25925 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25927 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25928 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25929 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25930 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25931 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25932 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25933 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25934 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25935 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25939 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25940 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25941 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25942 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25943 out the values of variables.
25944 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25945 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25948 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25949 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25950 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25951 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25952 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25953 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25954 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25955 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25956 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25959 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25960 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25961 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25962 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25963 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25964 remembered for later use.
25965 How it is used is described in the following section.
25971 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25972 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25973 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25974 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25975 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25979 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25980 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25982 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25984 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25985 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25986 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25987 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25988 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25989 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25990 given for the MAIL command.
25992 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25993 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25996 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25997 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25998 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25999 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26000 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26001 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26002 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26007 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26008 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26009 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26010 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26012 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26013 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26014 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26015 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26016 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26021 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26022 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26023 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26024 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26028 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26030 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26031 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26034 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26035 the mechanisms are advertised.
26037 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26038 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26039 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26040 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26041 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26042 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26043 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26045 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26047 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26049 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26050 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26051 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26054 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26056 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26057 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26058 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26060 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26061 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26062 command. This is the case if
26065 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26067 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26069 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26070 server authenticators.
26074 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26075 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26076 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26078 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26079 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26080 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26081 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26082 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26083 rejected with a 504 error.
26085 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26086 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26087 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26088 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26089 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26090 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26091 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26092 no successful authentication.
26097 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26098 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26099 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26100 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26101 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26102 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26103 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26107 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26109 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26110 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26111 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26112 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26113 command line to run this script on such data might be
26115 encode '\0user\0password'
26117 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26118 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26119 whose code value is zero.
26121 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26122 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26123 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26124 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26126 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26127 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26128 example, a command such as
26130 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26132 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26134 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26135 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26137 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26139 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26140 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26141 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26142 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26146 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26147 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26148 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26149 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26150 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26151 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26154 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26155 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26156 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26157 of the authenticator.
26160 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26161 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26162 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26163 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26164 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26165 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26166 delivery to be deferred.
26168 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26169 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26170 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26173 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26174 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26175 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26176 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26177 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26178 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26179 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26180 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26181 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26184 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26185 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26186 on and the transport running. For example, with a manualroute
26187 router given a host name, and DNS "round-robin" use by that name: if
26188 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26189 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26190 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26191 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26193 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26195 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26196 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26197 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26198 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26199 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26200 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26201 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26202 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26203 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26204 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26205 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26206 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26207 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26214 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26215 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26217 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26218 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26219 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26220 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26221 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26222 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26223 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26224 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26225 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26226 connections as you do for login accounts.
26228 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26229 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26230 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26232 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26233 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26234 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26236 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26237 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26238 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26241 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26242 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26243 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26244 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26245 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26246 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26247 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26249 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26250 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26251 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26252 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26253 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26254 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26255 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26257 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26258 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26259 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26260 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26262 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26263 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26264 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26266 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26267 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26268 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26269 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26270 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26271 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26272 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26273 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26274 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26275 string as the error text
26277 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26278 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26279 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26283 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26284 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26285 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26286 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26287 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26288 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26289 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26290 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26292 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26293 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26294 configured as follows:
26298 public_name = PLAIN
26300 server_condition = \
26301 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26302 server_set_id = $auth2
26304 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26305 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26306 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26307 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26309 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26310 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26311 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26312 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26316 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26318 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26320 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26321 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26325 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26326 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26328 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26329 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26330 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26331 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26332 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26334 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26335 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26336 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26338 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26339 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26340 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26341 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26342 This is an incorrect example:
26344 server_condition = \
26345 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26347 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26348 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26349 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26350 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26351 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26352 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26353 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26355 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26356 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26358 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26359 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26360 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26361 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26362 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26365 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26366 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26367 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26368 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26369 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26370 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26371 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26375 public_name = LOGIN
26376 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26377 server_condition = \
26378 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26379 server_set_id = $auth1
26381 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26382 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26383 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26384 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26386 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26387 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26388 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26389 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26390 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26394 public_name = LOGIN
26395 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26396 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26399 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26400 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26401 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26402 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26404 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26405 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26406 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26407 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26408 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26409 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26410 uninterpreted string.
26413 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26414 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26415 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26416 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26417 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26423 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26424 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26425 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26427 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26428 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26429 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26430 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26433 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26434 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26435 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26436 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26437 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26438 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26439 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26440 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26441 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26442 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26443 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26444 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26446 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26447 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26449 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26450 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26451 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26452 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26455 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26456 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26460 public_name = PLAIN
26461 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26463 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26464 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26465 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26469 public_name = LOGIN
26470 client_send = : username : mysecret
26472 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26473 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26475 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26476 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26482 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26484 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26485 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26486 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26487 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26488 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26489 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26490 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26491 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26492 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26493 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26494 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26495 available in plain text at either end.
26498 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26499 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26500 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26501 authenticator as a server:
26503 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26504 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26505 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26506 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26507 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26508 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26509 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26510 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26511 returned to the client.
26513 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26514 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26515 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26516 numeric variables for other things.
26518 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26519 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26520 user name, authentication fails.
26524 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26525 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26526 server_set_id = $auth1
26528 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26529 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26530 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26531 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26535 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26536 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26538 server_set_id = $auth1
26540 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26541 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26543 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26544 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26545 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26550 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26551 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26552 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26553 server_set_id = $auth1
26556 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26557 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26558 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26562 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26563 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26564 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26567 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26568 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26569 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26573 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26574 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26575 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26576 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26577 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26578 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26579 send the message to the current server.
26581 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26586 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26588 client_secret = secret
26590 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26591 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26595 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26596 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26598 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26599 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26600 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26601 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26603 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26604 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26606 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26607 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26608 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26609 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26610 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26612 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26613 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26614 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26615 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26617 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26618 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26619 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26620 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26621 depending on the driver you are using.
26623 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26624 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26625 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26626 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26627 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26630 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26631 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26632 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26633 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26634 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26635 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26636 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26637 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26640 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26641 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26642 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26643 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26644 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26645 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26649 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26650 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26651 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26652 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26655 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26656 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26657 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26658 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26662 driver = cyrus_sasl
26663 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26664 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26665 server_set_id = $auth1
26668 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26669 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26672 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26673 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26676 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26677 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26678 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26679 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26682 driver = cyrus_sasl
26683 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26684 server_set_id = $auth1
26687 driver = cyrus_sasl
26688 public_name = PLAIN
26689 server_set_id = $auth2
26691 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26692 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26693 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26694 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26695 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26701 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26702 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26703 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26704 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26705 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26706 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26707 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26708 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26709 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26710 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26712 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26714 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26715 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26716 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26717 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26721 public_name = PLAIN
26722 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26723 server_set_id = $auth1
26728 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26729 server_set_id = $auth1
26731 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26732 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26733 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26734 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26735 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26736 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26737 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26738 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26742 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26743 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26744 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26745 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26746 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26747 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26748 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26749 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26750 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26751 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26752 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26753 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26754 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26755 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26756 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26757 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26758 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26759 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26760 without code changes in Exim.
26763 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26764 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26765 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26766 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26767 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26770 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26771 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26772 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26774 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26775 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26776 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26778 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26779 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26780 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26783 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26784 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26785 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26786 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26789 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26790 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26791 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26792 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26797 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26798 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26799 server_set_id = $auth1
26803 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26804 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26805 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26806 the password itself.
26808 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26809 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26810 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26811 if available, else the empty string.
26812 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26813 else the empty string.
26815 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26817 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26818 option to be simply "true".
26821 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26822 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26823 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26826 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26827 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26828 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26829 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26832 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26833 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26834 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26835 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26838 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26839 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26840 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26843 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26844 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26845 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26846 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26848 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26849 meanings for these variables:
26852 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26853 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26855 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26856 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26858 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26859 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26862 On a per-mechanism basis:
26865 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26866 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26867 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26869 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26870 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26871 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26873 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26874 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26875 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26876 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26879 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26880 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26881 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26884 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26885 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26887 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26889 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26890 server_realm = imap.example.org
26891 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26892 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26893 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26894 server_condition = yes
26898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26899 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26901 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26902 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26903 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26904 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26905 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26906 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26907 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26910 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26911 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26912 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26913 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26915 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26916 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26917 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26918 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26920 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26921 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26922 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26926 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26927 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26928 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26929 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26931 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26932 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26933 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26934 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26936 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26938 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26939 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26941 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26942 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26943 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26948 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26949 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26951 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26952 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26953 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26954 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26955 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26956 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26957 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26958 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26959 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26960 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26961 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26962 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26963 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26967 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26968 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26970 The server sends back a challenge.
26972 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26973 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26976 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26980 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26981 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26982 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26984 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26985 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26986 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26987 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26988 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26989 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26990 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26991 for other things. For example:
26996 server_password = \
26997 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26999 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27000 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27006 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27007 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27008 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27012 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27013 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27016 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27017 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27020 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27021 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27022 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27028 client_username = msn/msn_username
27029 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27030 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27032 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27033 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27039 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27040 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27042 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27043 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27044 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27045 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27046 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27047 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27048 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27049 authentication based on client certificates.
27051 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27052 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27053 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27054 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27055 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27056 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27058 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27059 for which it must have been requested via the
27060 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27061 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27063 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27064 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27065 and can authenticate the connection.
27066 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27068 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27071 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27072 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27074 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27075 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27076 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27077 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27078 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27079 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27081 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27082 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27083 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27085 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27092 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27093 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27094 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
27096 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27097 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27098 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27100 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27102 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27103 of your configured trust-anchors
27104 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27105 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27106 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27107 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27109 . An alternative might use
27111 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27113 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27114 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27115 . This would help for per-device use.
27117 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27118 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27120 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27121 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27124 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27125 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27126 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27130 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27133 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27134 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27135 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27136 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27137 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27140 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27141 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27142 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27143 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27144 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27145 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27146 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27147 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27148 certificates are used.
27150 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27151 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27152 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27153 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27154 between them is encrypted.
27156 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27157 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27158 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27159 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27162 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27163 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27164 in order to get TLS to work.
27168 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27170 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27171 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27172 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27173 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27174 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27175 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27176 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27177 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27178 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27179 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27180 in preference to STARTTLS.
27182 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27183 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27184 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27186 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27187 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27188 reassigned for other use.
27189 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27191 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only supported submissions, not
27192 submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27193 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27195 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27196 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27197 the most common use is expected to be:
27199 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27201 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27202 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27203 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27204 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27205 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27208 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27209 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27216 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27217 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27218 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27219 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27220 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27224 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27228 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27229 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27231 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27234 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27235 cannot be the path of a directory
27236 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27237 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27239 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27241 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27242 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27243 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27244 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27245 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27247 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27248 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27249 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27250 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27251 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27252 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27253 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27256 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27257 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27259 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27260 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27261 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27262 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27264 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27265 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27267 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27268 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27269 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27270 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27274 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27275 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27276 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27277 but not the chosen filename.
27278 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27279 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27281 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27282 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27283 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27284 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27286 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27287 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27288 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27289 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27290 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27291 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27292 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27294 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27295 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27296 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27297 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27298 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27300 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27301 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27302 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27303 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27304 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27305 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27307 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27308 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27309 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27311 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27312 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27313 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27314 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27317 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27320 # chown exim:exim new-params
27321 # chmod 0600 new-params
27322 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27323 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27324 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27325 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27326 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27327 # chmod 0400 new-params
27328 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27330 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27331 stalling is removed.
27333 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27334 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27335 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27336 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27337 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27338 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27339 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27340 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27341 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27342 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27343 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27345 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27346 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27347 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27348 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27350 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27351 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27352 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27353 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27354 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27357 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27358 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27359 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27360 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27361 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27362 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27363 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27364 directly to this function call.
27365 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27366 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27367 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27368 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27371 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27373 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27374 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27375 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27378 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27379 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27380 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27384 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27387 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27388 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27391 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27392 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27394 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27395 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27398 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27399 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27400 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27401 not be moved to the end of the list.
27404 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27407 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27408 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27411 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27412 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27413 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27414 choice of clients used:
27416 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27417 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27422 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27424 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27428 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27430 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27431 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27432 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27433 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27434 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27435 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27436 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27437 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27438 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27439 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27441 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27442 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27444 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27445 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27446 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27447 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27448 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27449 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27451 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27452 "Priority strings". This is online as
27453 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27454 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27455 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27456 then the example code
27457 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27458 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27462 # Disable older versions of protocols
27463 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27466 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27467 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27468 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27470 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27471 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27472 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27473 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27477 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27483 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27484 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27485 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27486 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27487 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27488 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27489 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27491 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27492 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27494 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27495 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27496 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27499 554 Security failure
27501 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27502 rejected with a 554 error code.
27504 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27505 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27507 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27508 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27509 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27510 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27512 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27514 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27516 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27517 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27519 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27520 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27521 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27522 that goes with it. These files need to be
27523 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27524 always be given as full path names.
27525 The key must not be password-protected.
27526 They can be the same file if both the
27527 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27528 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27529 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27530 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27531 the server's certificate.
27533 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27534 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27535 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27536 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27537 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27538 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27540 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27541 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27542 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27544 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27545 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27546 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27549 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27550 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27551 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27553 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27555 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27556 with the parameters contained in the file.
27557 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27562 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27563 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27564 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27565 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27571 for a way of generating file data.
27573 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27574 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27575 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27576 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27577 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27579 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27580 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27581 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27582 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27583 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27584 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27585 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27586 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27587 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27589 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27590 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27591 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27592 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27593 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27594 documentation for more details.
27596 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27597 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27600 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27601 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27602 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27603 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27604 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27605 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27606 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27607 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27608 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27609 expected certificates.
27610 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27611 an explicit file or,
27612 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27613 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27615 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27618 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27619 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27620 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27622 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27624 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27626 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27627 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27628 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27629 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27630 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27631 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27632 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27633 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27634 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27635 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27637 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27638 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27639 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27640 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27642 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27643 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27644 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27645 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27646 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27647 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27650 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27651 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27652 .cindex "revocation list"
27653 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27654 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27655 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27656 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27657 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27658 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27659 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27661 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27662 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27664 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27665 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27666 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27667 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27668 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27669 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27671 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27672 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27673 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27674 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27676 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27677 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27678 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27679 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27680 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27681 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27682 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27683 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27685 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27686 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27687 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27689 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27690 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27691 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27692 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27693 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27695 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27696 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27697 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27698 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27699 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27702 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27703 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27706 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27707 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27708 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27709 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27710 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27711 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27713 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27714 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27716 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27719 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27720 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27721 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27723 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27724 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27725 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27731 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27732 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27733 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27734 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27735 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27736 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27737 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27738 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27739 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27741 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27742 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27743 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27744 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27745 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27747 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27748 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27749 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27750 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27751 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27754 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27755 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27756 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27757 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27758 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27759 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27760 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27761 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27762 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27763 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27766 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27767 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27768 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27769 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27771 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27772 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27774 the system default set (depending on library version),
27776 or (depending on library version) a directory.
27777 The client verifies the server's certificate
27778 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27779 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27780 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27781 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27783 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27784 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27785 or need not succeed respectively.
27787 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27788 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27789 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27791 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27792 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27793 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27796 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27797 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27798 for OCSP to be relevant.
27801 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27802 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27803 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27804 alternative hosts, if any.
27807 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27808 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27809 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27813 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27814 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27815 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27816 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27817 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27819 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27820 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27821 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27822 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27823 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27824 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27825 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27826 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27827 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27828 outgoing connection.
27832 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27833 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27834 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27835 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27836 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27837 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27838 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27839 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27840 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27841 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27844 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27845 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27848 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27849 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27850 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27851 be of limited use in that environment.
27853 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27854 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27855 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27856 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27857 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27859 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27860 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27861 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27862 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27863 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27865 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27866 received from a client.
27867 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27869 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27870 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27871 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27874 &%tls_certificate%&
27880 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27885 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27886 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27887 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27888 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27889 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27890 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27891 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27893 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27896 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27897 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27898 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27899 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27901 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27902 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27903 built, then you have SNI support).
27907 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27909 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27910 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27911 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27912 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27913 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27914 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27915 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27916 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
27917 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
27918 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
27920 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
27921 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
27922 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
27923 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
27924 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27925 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27926 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27928 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27929 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27930 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27931 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27932 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27933 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27934 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27935 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27936 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27938 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27939 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27940 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27941 information is recorded.
27943 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27944 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27945 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27950 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27951 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27952 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27953 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27954 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27955 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27956 to Apache, currently at
27958 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27960 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27961 links to further files.
27962 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27963 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27964 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27966 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27970 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27971 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27972 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27973 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27974 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27975 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27976 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27977 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27978 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27979 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27980 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27981 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27982 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27984 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27985 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27986 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27987 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27991 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27992 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27993 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27994 with OpenSSL, like this:
27995 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27996 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27998 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28001 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28002 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28003 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28004 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28005 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28006 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28007 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28009 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28010 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28011 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28012 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28013 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28014 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28016 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28017 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28018 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28019 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28020 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28021 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28022 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28023 be a sensible resolution).
28025 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28026 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28027 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28029 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28030 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28031 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28032 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28033 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28034 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28036 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28037 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28038 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28039 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
28040 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28041 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28046 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28048 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28049 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28050 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28051 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28052 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28053 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28055 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28056 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28057 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28059 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28060 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28062 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28063 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28064 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28066 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28067 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28068 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28070 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28071 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is traceable to the one
28072 defined by (one of?) the TSLA records
28074 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28075 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28076 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28077 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28079 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3). The latter specifies
28080 the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server (and should be the sole one transmitted
28081 during the TLS handshake); this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28082 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28083 well-known one. A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate which is used to sign
28084 cerver certificates, but running one securely does require careful arrangement. If a private CA is used
28085 then either all clients must be primed with it, or (probably simpler) the server TLS handshake must transmit
28086 the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate. If a public CA is used then all clients must be primed with it
28087 (losing one advantage of DANE) - but the attack surface is reduced from all public CAs to that single CA.
28088 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28089 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28091 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28093 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28094 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28097 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28098 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28103 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28105 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28107 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28108 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28109 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28112 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28113 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28117 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28118 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28119 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28120 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28121 control the OCSP request.
28123 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28124 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28127 For client-side DANE there are two new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%& and &%hosts_require_dane%&.
28128 The latter variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28130 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28132 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28133 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28134 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28135 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28137 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28141 tls_try_verify_hosts
28142 tls_verify_certificates
28144 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28147 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28148 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28150 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28152 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28154 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28155 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28156 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28157 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28159 .cindex DANE reporting
28160 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28161 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28162 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28163 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28164 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28165 Section 4.3 of that document.
28167 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28172 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28175 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28176 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28177 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28178 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28179 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28180 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
28181 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28182 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28183 one very small ACL:
28187 accept hosts = one.host.only
28189 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28190 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28192 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28193 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28194 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28195 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28196 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28197 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28198 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28199 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28202 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28203 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28204 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28207 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28208 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28209 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28210 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28211 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28212 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28213 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28214 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28215 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28216 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28217 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28218 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28219 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28220 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28221 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28222 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28223 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28224 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28225 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28226 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28229 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28230 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28231 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28232 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28233 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28234 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28235 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28236 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28237 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28238 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28239 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28240 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28241 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28242 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28243 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28244 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28245 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28246 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28247 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28248 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28251 For example, if you set
28253 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28255 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28256 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28257 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28258 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28259 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28260 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28261 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28264 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28265 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28266 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28267 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28268 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28269 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28270 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28271 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28272 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28273 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28274 in any of these ACLs.
28276 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28277 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28278 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28279 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28280 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28281 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28282 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28283 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28285 control = suppress_local_fixups
28287 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28288 run, it is too late.
28290 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28291 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28293 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28294 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28295 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28298 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28299 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28300 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28301 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28302 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28303 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28304 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28305 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28306 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28309 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28310 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28311 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28312 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28313 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28314 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28315 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28316 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28317 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28319 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28320 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28321 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28323 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28324 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28325 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28326 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28330 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28331 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28332 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28333 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28334 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28335 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28336 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28337 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28338 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28339 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28341 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28342 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28343 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28344 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28345 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28346 associated with the DATA command.
28348 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28349 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28350 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28351 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28352 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28353 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28354 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28355 the data specified is received.
28357 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28358 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28359 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28360 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28361 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28364 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28365 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28366 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28367 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28369 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28370 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28371 enabled (which is the default).
28373 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28374 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28375 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28377 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28379 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
28382 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28383 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28384 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28386 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28389 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28390 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28391 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28392 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28393 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28394 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28395 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28398 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28399 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28400 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28401 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28402 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28403 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28404 for some or all recipients.
28406 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28407 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28408 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28409 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28410 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28412 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28413 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28414 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28416 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28417 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28419 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28420 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28421 the feature was not requested by the client.
28423 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28424 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28425 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28426 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28427 does not in fact control any access.
28428 For this reason, it may only accept
28429 or warn as its final result.
28431 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28432 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28433 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28434 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28436 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28437 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28439 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28440 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28443 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28444 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28445 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28446 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28447 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28450 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28451 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28452 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28453 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28454 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28455 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28456 situation even worse.
28458 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28459 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28460 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28463 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28464 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28465 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28466 connection. The possible values are:
28468 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28469 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28470 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28471 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28472 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28473 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28474 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28475 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28476 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28477 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28479 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28480 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28481 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28482 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28483 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28487 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28488 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28489 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28490 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28492 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28493 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28495 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28496 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
28497 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28498 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28499 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28501 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28502 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28503 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28506 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28507 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28508 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28509 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28510 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28511 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28513 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28514 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28515 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28517 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28518 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28519 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28520 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28522 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28523 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28524 matches the string.
28526 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28527 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28528 want to have something like
28530 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28532 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28533 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28539 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28540 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28541 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28542 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28543 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28544 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28545 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28546 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28547 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28549 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28550 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28551 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28554 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28555 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28556 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28557 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28559 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28560 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28561 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28562 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28563 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28564 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28565 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28567 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28568 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28571 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28572 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28573 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28577 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28578 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28579 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28580 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28581 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28582 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28584 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28585 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28586 used to accept or reject anything.
28588 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28589 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28590 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28591 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28593 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28594 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28595 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28596 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28597 configuration file.
28602 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28603 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28605 .vindex &$local_part$&
28606 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28607 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28608 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28609 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28610 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28611 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28612 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28613 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28614 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28616 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28617 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28618 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28621 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28622 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28623 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28624 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28625 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28628 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28629 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28630 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28631 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28632 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28633 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28634 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28635 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28641 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28642 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28643 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28644 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28645 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28646 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28647 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28648 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28649 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28650 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28651 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28652 unencrypted connections.
28655 accept encrypted = *
28656 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28658 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28660 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28661 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28662 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28663 option to do this.)
28667 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28668 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28669 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28670 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28671 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28672 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28673 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28675 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28676 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28677 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28680 deny dnslists = list1.example
28681 dnslists = list2.example
28683 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28684 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28685 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28686 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28687 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28690 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28691 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28694 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28695 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28696 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28697 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28698 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28699 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28700 check a RCPT command:
28702 accept domains = +local_domains
28706 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28707 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28708 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28709 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28712 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28713 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28714 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28717 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28718 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28719 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28720 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28721 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28722 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28724 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28725 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28727 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28728 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28729 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28731 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28732 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28733 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28738 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28739 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28740 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28741 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28742 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28743 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28744 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28748 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28749 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28750 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28753 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28755 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28759 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28760 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28761 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28762 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28763 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28764 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28765 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28766 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28767 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28769 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28770 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28771 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28775 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28776 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28777 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28779 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28780 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28782 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28783 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28786 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28787 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28788 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28789 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28791 require message = Sender did not verify
28794 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28795 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28796 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28797 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28800 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28801 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28802 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28803 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28804 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28805 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28806 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28808 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28809 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28810 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28811 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28812 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28814 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28815 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28816 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28817 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28818 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28819 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28823 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28824 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28825 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28826 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28828 warn !verify = sender
28829 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28833 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28835 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28836 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28837 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28838 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28839 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28843 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28844 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28845 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28846 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28847 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28848 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28849 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28850 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28851 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28852 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28854 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28855 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28856 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28857 on the same SMTP connection.
28859 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28860 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28861 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28864 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28865 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28866 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28868 accept hosts = whatever
28869 set acl_m4 = some value
28870 accept authenticated = *
28871 set acl_c_auth = yes
28873 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28874 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28875 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28877 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28878 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28879 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28880 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28881 error is generated.
28883 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28884 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28887 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28888 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28889 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28890 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28892 deny domains = *.dom.example
28893 !verify = recipient
28895 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28896 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28897 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28898 two statements are equivalent:
28900 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28901 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28903 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28904 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28906 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28907 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28908 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28910 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28911 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28912 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28913 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28915 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28916 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28917 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28918 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28919 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28920 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28921 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28923 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28924 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28925 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28926 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28927 message is handled.
28929 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28930 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28931 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28932 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28934 require message = Can't verify sender
28936 message = Can't verify recipient
28938 message = This message cannot be used
28940 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28941 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28942 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28943 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28944 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28945 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28947 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28948 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28949 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28950 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28953 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28954 message = Invalid sender from client host
28956 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28957 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28961 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28962 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28963 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28966 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28967 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28968 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28969 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28971 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28972 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28973 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28974 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28975 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28976 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28977 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28978 write rather ugly lines like this:
28980 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28982 Instead, all you need is
28984 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28987 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28988 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28989 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28990 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28991 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28992 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28993 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28994 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28996 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28997 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28998 in several different ways. For example:
29000 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29001 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29002 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29006 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29008 accept ...some conditions
29009 control = queue_only
29011 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29012 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29015 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29017 accept ...some conditions...
29018 control = queue_only
29019 ...some more conditions...
29021 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29022 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29023 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29027 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29028 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29031 warn ...some conditions...
29035 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29036 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29040 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29041 &%require%& verb. For example:
29043 require control = no_multiline_responses
29047 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29048 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29050 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29051 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29052 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29053 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29054 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29055 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29057 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29060 deny ...some conditions...
29063 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29064 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29067 ...some conditions...
29069 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29070 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29072 warn ...some conditions...
29078 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29079 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29080 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29081 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29082 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29083 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29084 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29088 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29089 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29090 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29091 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29092 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29093 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29094 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29097 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29098 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29099 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29100 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29102 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29103 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29105 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29108 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29109 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29111 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29112 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29113 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29116 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29117 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29118 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29119 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29120 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29121 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29124 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29125 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29126 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29129 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29130 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29131 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29132 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29133 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29134 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29136 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29137 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29138 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29139 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29140 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29141 logging rejections.
29144 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29145 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29146 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29147 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29148 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29149 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29150 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29151 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29153 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29154 &` log_reject_target =`&
29156 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29157 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29161 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29162 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29163 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29164 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29165 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29166 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29167 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29170 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29171 &` control = freeze`&
29172 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29174 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29175 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29176 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29179 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29180 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29184 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29185 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29186 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29187 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29188 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29189 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29190 &%accept%& for details.)
29192 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29193 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29194 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29195 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29196 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29198 require message = Host not recognized
29201 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29204 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29205 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29206 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29207 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29208 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29209 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29210 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29211 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29212 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29215 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29216 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29217 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29219 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29220 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29222 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29223 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29224 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29227 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29228 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29230 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29231 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29232 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29235 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29236 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29237 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29239 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29240 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29241 However, the original message is available in the variable
29242 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29243 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29244 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29245 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29247 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29248 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29249 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29250 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29251 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29252 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29256 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29257 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29258 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29259 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29261 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29263 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29264 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29265 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29266 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29269 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29270 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29271 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29272 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29275 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29276 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29277 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29278 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29281 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29282 .cindex "UDP communications"
29283 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29284 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29285 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29286 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29287 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29288 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29289 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29292 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29293 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29300 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29301 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29302 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29305 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29306 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29307 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29308 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29309 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29310 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29311 not work without it. For example:
29313 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29314 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29316 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29317 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29318 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29319 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29320 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29323 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29324 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29325 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29326 .cindex "case of local parts"
29327 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29328 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29329 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29330 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29331 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29332 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29335 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29336 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29337 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29338 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29339 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29341 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29342 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29345 warn control = caseful_local_part
29346 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29348 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29350 control = caselower_local_part
29352 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29353 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29356 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29357 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29358 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29359 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29361 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29362 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29363 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29364 is used for all recipients of the message,
29365 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29366 and data is copied from one to the other.
29368 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29369 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29370 If a recipient-verify callout
29372 connection is subsequently
29373 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29374 any subsequent recipients and the data,
29375 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29377 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29378 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29379 Note also that headers cannot be
29380 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29381 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29382 The Received-By: header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29383 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29384 this will affect the timestamp.
29386 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29387 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29388 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29389 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29392 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29393 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29394 before the entire message has been received from the source.
29395 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29399 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29400 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29401 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29402 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29403 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29405 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29407 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29408 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29409 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29410 and does not queue the message.
29411 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29413 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29415 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29418 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29419 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29420 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29421 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29422 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29423 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29424 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29425 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29426 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29428 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29429 with the &'kill'& option.
29430 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29434 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29435 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29436 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29437 control = debug/kill
29441 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29442 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29443 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29444 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29445 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29448 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29449 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29450 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29451 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29452 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29453 strings or to numeric value.
29454 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29455 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29456 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29458 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29459 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29460 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29461 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29462 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29465 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29466 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29467 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29468 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29469 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29470 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29471 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29472 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29474 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29475 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29476 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29477 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29478 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29479 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29483 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29484 .cindex "fake defer"
29485 .cindex "defer, fake"
29486 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29487 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29488 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29489 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29490 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29492 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29493 .cindex "fake rejection"
29494 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29495 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29496 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29497 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29498 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29499 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29500 the same SMTP connection.
29502 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29503 message is supplied, the following is used:
29505 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29506 550-kept for evaluation.
29507 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29508 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29510 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29512 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29513 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29514 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29515 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29516 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29517 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29520 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29521 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29522 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29523 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29525 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29526 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29527 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29528 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29529 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29530 disables such output flushing.
29532 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29533 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29534 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29535 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29536 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29537 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29539 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29540 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29541 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29542 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29543 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29544 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29545 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29546 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29547 to be useful in production.
29549 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29550 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29551 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29552 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29553 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29555 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29556 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29557 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29558 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29559 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29560 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29563 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29564 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29565 verification failed"&) is sent.
29567 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29571 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29572 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29574 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29575 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29576 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29577 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29578 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29579 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29580 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29582 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29583 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29584 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29585 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29586 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29587 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29588 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29589 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29590 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29591 same SMTP connection.
29593 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29594 .cindex "message" "submission"
29595 .cindex "submission mode"
29596 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29597 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29598 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29599 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29600 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29601 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29602 late (the message has already been created).
29604 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29605 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29606 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29607 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29608 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29610 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29611 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29612 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29613 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29614 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29617 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29618 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29620 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29622 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29625 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29626 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29627 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29628 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29631 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29632 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29634 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29635 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29637 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29641 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29642 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29645 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29647 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29648 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29650 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29652 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29657 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29658 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29659 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29660 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29661 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29662 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29664 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29665 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29666 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29668 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29669 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29670 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29671 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29672 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29675 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29676 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29678 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29679 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29680 contains one or more newlines that
29681 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29682 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29683 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29685 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29686 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29687 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29688 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29689 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29690 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29691 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29692 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29693 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29694 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29695 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29697 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29698 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29700 until they are added to the
29701 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29702 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29703 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29704 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29705 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29706 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29707 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29709 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29711 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29712 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29714 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29715 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29717 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29718 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29720 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29721 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29722 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29723 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29726 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29727 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29728 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29729 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29730 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29731 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29732 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29735 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29736 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29737 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29738 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29739 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29741 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29742 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29743 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29744 to be a header name first.) For example:
29746 warn add_header = \
29747 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29749 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29750 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29751 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29752 up in reverse order.
29754 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29755 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29756 system filter or in a router or transport.
29760 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29761 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29762 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29763 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29764 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29765 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29767 warn message = Remove internal headers
29768 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29770 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29771 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29772 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29773 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29774 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29775 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29777 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29778 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29780 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29781 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29782 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29783 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29784 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29786 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29787 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29788 warn message = Remove internal headers
29789 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29791 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29792 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29793 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29794 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29795 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29796 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29797 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29798 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29799 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29800 would have been removed.
29802 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29803 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29804 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29805 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29806 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29807 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29808 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29809 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29810 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29812 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29813 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29815 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29816 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29818 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29819 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29821 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29822 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29823 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29824 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29827 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29828 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29829 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29834 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29835 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29836 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29837 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29838 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29839 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29841 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29842 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29843 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29844 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29845 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29846 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29847 The conditions are as follows:
29851 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29852 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29853 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29854 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29855 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29856 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29857 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29858 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29859 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29860 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29861 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29862 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29864 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29865 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29866 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29867 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29868 The name and values are expanded separately.
29869 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29870 will act as argument separators.
29872 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29873 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29874 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29875 conditions are tested.
29877 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29878 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29879 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29880 for different local users or different local domains.
29882 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29883 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29884 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29885 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29886 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29887 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29888 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29893 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29894 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29895 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29896 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29897 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29898 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29899 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29900 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29901 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29902 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29903 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29904 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29907 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29908 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29909 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29910 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29911 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29912 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29913 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29914 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29916 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29917 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29918 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29919 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29920 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29921 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29922 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29923 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29924 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29925 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29927 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29928 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29929 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29930 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29931 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29932 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29933 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29934 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29935 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29938 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29939 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29942 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29943 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29944 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29945 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29946 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29947 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29948 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29954 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29955 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29956 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29957 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29958 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29959 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29960 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29962 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29964 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29965 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29966 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29968 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29969 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29970 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29971 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29972 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29973 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29975 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29976 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29978 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29979 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29981 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29982 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29983 statement can then check the IP address.
29985 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
29986 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
29987 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
29988 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
29990 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
29991 message = $host_data
29993 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
29995 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
29996 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
29997 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
29998 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
29999 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30000 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30001 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30002 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30003 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30004 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30006 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30007 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30008 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30009 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30010 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30011 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30012 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30014 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30015 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30016 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30017 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30018 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30019 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30020 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30023 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30024 .cindex "rate limiting"
30025 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30026 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30028 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30029 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30030 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30031 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30032 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30033 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30035 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30036 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30037 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30038 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30039 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30040 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30041 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30043 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30044 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30045 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30046 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30047 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30048 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30049 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30050 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30051 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30052 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30053 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30054 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30055 influence the sender checking.
30057 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30058 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30060 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30061 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30062 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30063 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30064 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30065 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30069 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30070 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30072 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30073 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30074 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30075 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30076 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30077 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30079 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30080 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30081 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30082 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30083 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30084 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30085 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30086 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30087 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30088 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30090 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30091 .cindex "CSA verification"
30092 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30093 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30094 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30096 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30097 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30098 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30099 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30100 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30101 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30102 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30103 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30104 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30105 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30107 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30108 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30109 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30111 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30112 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30113 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30114 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30115 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30116 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30117 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30118 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30119 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30120 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30121 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30122 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30123 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30124 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30125 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30127 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30128 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30129 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30130 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30133 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30134 !verify = header_sender
30137 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30138 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30139 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30140 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30141 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30142 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30143 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30144 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30145 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30146 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30147 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30148 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30149 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30152 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30153 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30157 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30158 common as they used to be.
30160 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30161 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30162 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30163 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30164 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30165 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30166 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30167 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30168 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30169 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30170 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30171 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30172 independently of this condition.
30174 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30175 option), this condition is always true.
30178 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30179 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30180 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30181 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30182 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30183 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30184 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30185 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30186 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30188 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30189 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30192 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30193 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30194 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30195 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30196 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30197 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30198 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30199 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30200 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30201 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30202 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30203 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30204 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30205 value for the child address.
30207 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30208 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30209 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30210 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30211 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30212 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30213 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30214 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30215 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30216 original IP address.
30218 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30219 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30221 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30222 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30224 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30225 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30226 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30227 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30228 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30229 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30230 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30231 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30232 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30234 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30235 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30236 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30237 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30238 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30239 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30240 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30242 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30243 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30244 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30246 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30247 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30248 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30249 verified as a sender.
30251 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30252 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30253 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30255 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30261 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30262 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30263 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30264 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30265 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30266 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30267 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30268 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30269 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30270 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30272 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30273 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30275 the following records are looked up:
30277 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30278 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30280 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30281 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30282 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30283 use two separate conditions:
30285 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30286 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30288 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30289 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30290 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30293 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30294 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30295 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30296 following special items in the list:
30298 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30299 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30300 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30302 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30303 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30304 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30305 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30307 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30309 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30310 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30312 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30313 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30314 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30316 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30318 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30319 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30320 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30321 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30322 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30323 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30327 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30328 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30329 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30330 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30331 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30333 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30335 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30336 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30337 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30338 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30343 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30344 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30345 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30346 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30347 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30348 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30349 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30351 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30352 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30354 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30355 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30356 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30357 up by this example is
30359 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30361 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30362 addresses. For example:
30364 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30365 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30367 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30368 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30373 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30374 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30375 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30376 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30377 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30378 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30379 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30380 either to double the separators like this:
30382 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30384 or to change the separator character, like this:
30386 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30388 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30389 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30390 occurs. Consider this condition:
30392 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30394 The DNS lookups that occur are:
30396 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30397 a.domain.black.list.tld
30399 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30400 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30401 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30402 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30403 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30404 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30405 error for a previous item.
30407 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30408 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30410 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30411 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30413 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30414 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30416 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30417 $sender_address_domain \
30418 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30420 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30421 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30422 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30424 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30425 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30426 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30427 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30429 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30431 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30432 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30434 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30435 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30440 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30441 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30442 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30443 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30444 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30445 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30449 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30451 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30452 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30453 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30455 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30456 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30457 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30460 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30461 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30462 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30463 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30464 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30465 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30466 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30467 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30468 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30469 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30470 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30471 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30472 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30473 cases, for example:
30475 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30477 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30478 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30479 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30480 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30482 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30484 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30485 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30487 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30488 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30489 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30490 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30491 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30494 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30495 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30496 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30498 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30499 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30501 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30506 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30507 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30508 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30509 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30512 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30514 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30515 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30516 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30517 describes how multiple records are handled.
30519 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30520 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30521 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30523 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30525 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30526 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30527 first. For example:
30529 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30530 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30533 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30534 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30535 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30536 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30537 tested. For example:
30539 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30541 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30542 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30543 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30545 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30547 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30552 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30553 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30556 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30558 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30559 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30561 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30563 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30564 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30565 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30566 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30568 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30569 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30571 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30572 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30574 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30575 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30577 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30578 Consider this example:
30580 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30582 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30585 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30587 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30589 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30590 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30591 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30593 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30598 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30599 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30600 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30601 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30602 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30603 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30605 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30607 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30608 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30609 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30610 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30611 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30612 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30615 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30616 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30617 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30619 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30620 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30623 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30625 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30626 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30628 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30630 for the condition to be true.
30633 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30634 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30636 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30637 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30639 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30641 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30642 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30644 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30645 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30647 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30649 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30650 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30652 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30654 for the condition to be false.
30656 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30657 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30662 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30663 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30664 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30665 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30666 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30667 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30668 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30669 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30670 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30673 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30674 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30675 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30676 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30677 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30678 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30679 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30682 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30683 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30685 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30686 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30688 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30689 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30690 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30691 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30692 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30693 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30695 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30696 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30697 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30699 reject dnslists = \
30700 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30701 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30702 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30703 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30705 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30706 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30707 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30711 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30712 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30713 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30714 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30715 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30716 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30718 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30719 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30721 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30722 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30723 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30725 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30727 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30728 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30730 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30731 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30733 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30734 dnslists = some.list.example
30737 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30738 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30739 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30741 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30744 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30745 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30746 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30747 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30748 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30749 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30750 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30751 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30752 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30753 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30755 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30757 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30758 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30760 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30761 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30762 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30765 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30766 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30767 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30768 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30769 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30770 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30771 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30772 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30773 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30775 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30776 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30777 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30778 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30780 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30781 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30782 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30783 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30784 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30785 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30786 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30787 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30788 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30789 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30791 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30792 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30793 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30796 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30797 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30798 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30799 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30800 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30801 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30803 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30804 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30805 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30806 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30807 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30808 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30809 the &%count=%& option.
30812 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30813 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30814 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30815 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30816 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30818 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30819 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30820 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30821 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30823 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30824 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30825 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30826 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30827 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30828 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30829 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30831 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30832 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30833 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30834 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30835 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30836 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30837 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30839 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30840 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30841 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30842 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30845 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30846 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30847 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30848 multiple different commands.
30850 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30851 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30852 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30853 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30854 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30856 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30859 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30860 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30861 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30862 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30863 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30865 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30866 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30868 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30869 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30870 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30871 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30875 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30876 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30877 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30880 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30881 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30882 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30885 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30886 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30887 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30888 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30889 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30890 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30893 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30894 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30895 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30896 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30897 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30900 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30901 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30902 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30903 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30904 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30905 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30908 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30909 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30910 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30911 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30912 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30913 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30914 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30915 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30916 from getting any email through.
30918 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30919 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30920 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30921 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30922 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30923 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30924 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30925 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30927 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30931 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30932 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30933 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30934 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30935 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30936 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30937 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30938 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30939 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30941 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30942 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30943 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30944 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30945 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30946 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30948 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30949 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30952 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30953 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30954 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30955 required increases with larger limits.
30957 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30958 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30959 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30960 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30961 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30962 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30963 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30964 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30965 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30969 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30970 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30971 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30972 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30973 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30974 message. For example:
30976 # Log all senders' rates
30977 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30978 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30980 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30981 # at the decimal point.
30982 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30983 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30984 $sender_rate_limit }s
30986 # Keep authenticated users under control
30987 deny authenticated = *
30988 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
30990 # System-wide rate limit
30991 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
30992 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
30994 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
30995 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
30996 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
30997 messages per $sender_rate_period
30998 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
30999 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31000 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31002 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31003 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31004 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31005 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31006 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31007 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31008 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31012 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31013 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31014 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31015 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31016 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31017 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31018 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31019 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31020 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31022 verify = sender/callout
31023 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31025 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31026 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31027 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31028 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31029 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31030 The available options are as follows:
31033 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31034 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31035 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31037 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31038 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31039 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31040 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31042 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31043 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31045 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31046 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31047 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31048 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31051 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31052 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31053 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31054 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31055 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31056 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31059 warn !verify = sender
31060 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31062 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31063 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31064 verification failure.
31066 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31067 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31070 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31071 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31073 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31075 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31076 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31077 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31079 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31081 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31084 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31085 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31090 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31091 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31092 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31093 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31094 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31095 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31096 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31097 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31098 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31099 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31100 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31101 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31104 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31105 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31106 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31107 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31108 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31109 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31111 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31112 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31113 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31114 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31115 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31117 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31118 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31119 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31120 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31121 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31122 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31123 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31124 supplies a host list.
31125 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31127 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31128 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31129 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31130 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31131 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31132 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31133 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31135 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31136 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31137 following SMTP commands are sent:
31139 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31141 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31144 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31147 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31150 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31151 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31152 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31153 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31154 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31155 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31157 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31158 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31159 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31160 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31161 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31163 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31164 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31165 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31166 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31167 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31172 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31173 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31174 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31175 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31177 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31179 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31180 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31181 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31185 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31186 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31187 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31190 verify = sender/callout=5s
31192 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31193 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31194 the &%connect%& parameter.
31197 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31198 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31199 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31200 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31202 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31204 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31206 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31207 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31208 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31209 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31210 updated in this circumstance.
31212 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31213 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31214 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31215 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31216 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31217 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31220 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31221 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31222 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31223 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31224 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31225 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31226 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31227 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31228 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31229 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31231 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31233 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31236 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31237 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31238 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31241 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31243 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31244 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31245 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31246 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31247 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31250 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31251 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31252 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31253 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31255 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31256 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31257 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31258 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31259 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31260 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31261 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31262 made, until the cache record expires.
31264 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31265 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31266 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31269 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31271 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31272 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31274 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31276 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31277 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31278 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31279 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31283 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31284 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31285 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31286 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31287 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31289 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31291 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31292 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31293 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31294 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31295 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31297 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31298 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31299 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31301 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31303 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31304 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31305 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31306 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31307 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31309 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31310 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31312 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31314 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31315 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31316 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31317 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31318 usefulness of callout caching.
31321 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31323 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31325 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
31326 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31327 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31328 when that is used for the connections.
31329 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31330 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31331 if the use_sender option is used,
31332 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31333 and if no other callouts intervene.
31336 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31337 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31338 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31339 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31340 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31341 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31342 these circumstances.
31344 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31345 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31346 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31347 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31348 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31349 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31350 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31352 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31353 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31354 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31355 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31360 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31361 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31362 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31363 .cindex "caching" "callout"
31364 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31365 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31366 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31367 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31368 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31369 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31371 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31372 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31375 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31376 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31377 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31379 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31380 commands up to and including
31384 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31385 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31386 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31387 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31388 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31389 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31390 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31392 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31393 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31394 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31395 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31396 will eventually be noticed.
31398 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31399 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31400 behaviour will be the same.
31404 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31405 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31406 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31407 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31408 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31409 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31412 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31414 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31415 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31416 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31417 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31418 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31419 550 Sender verification failed
31421 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31422 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31423 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31424 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31427 verify = sender/no_details
31430 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31431 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31432 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31433 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31434 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31435 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31436 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31439 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31440 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31441 verification also fails.
31443 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31444 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31447 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31448 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31449 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31452 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31454 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31455 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31456 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31457 verification to succeed.
31459 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31460 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31461 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31462 option. For example:
31464 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31466 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31467 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31469 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31470 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31471 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31472 address and a report is output for each of them.
31476 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31477 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31478 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31479 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31480 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31481 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31482 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31486 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31487 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31488 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31489 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31490 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31491 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31493 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31494 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31495 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31496 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31499 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31501 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31503 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31504 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31506 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31507 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31510 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31511 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31513 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31515 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31516 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31517 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31518 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31521 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31523 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31524 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31525 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31527 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31528 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31529 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31530 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31531 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31532 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31533 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31534 of legitimate HELO domains.
31536 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31537 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31538 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31539 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31542 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31544 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31545 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31546 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31551 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31552 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31553 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31554 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31555 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31556 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31557 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31558 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31560 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31561 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31562 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31563 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31564 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31565 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31566 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31567 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31569 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31570 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31573 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31574 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31577 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31578 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31581 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31582 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31584 recipients = +batv_senders
31586 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31587 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31589 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31590 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31591 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31593 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31594 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31595 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31596 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31597 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31599 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31600 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31601 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31602 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31603 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31604 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31605 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31607 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31608 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31609 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31610 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31614 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31616 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31617 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31618 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31621 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31624 external_smtp_batv:
31626 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31627 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31628 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31629 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31632 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31636 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31637 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31638 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31639 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31640 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31641 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31642 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31643 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31644 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31645 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31647 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31648 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31649 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31650 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31651 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31652 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31654 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31656 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31657 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31658 system to arbitrary domains.
31661 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31662 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31663 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31664 example, suppose you want to do the following:
31667 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31668 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31669 &'my.dom2.example'&.
31671 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31672 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31674 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31675 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31679 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31681 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31682 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31683 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31685 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31689 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31690 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31692 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31693 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31694 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31695 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31696 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31697 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31698 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31702 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31703 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31704 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31705 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31706 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31714 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31715 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31716 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31717 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31718 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31719 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31722 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31723 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31724 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31725 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31726 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31728 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31729 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31730 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31733 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31734 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31736 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31737 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31738 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31740 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31741 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31743 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31746 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31749 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31750 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31751 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31752 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31753 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31754 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31756 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31757 temporarily created in a file called:
31759 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31761 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31762 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31763 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31764 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31765 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31767 control = no_mbox_unspool
31769 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31770 same directory by default.
31774 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31775 .cindex "virus scanning"
31776 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31777 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31778 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31779 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31780 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31781 in memory and thus are much faster.
31783 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31784 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31786 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31787 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31788 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31789 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31791 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31793 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31795 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31797 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31799 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31800 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
31802 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
31807 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31808 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31809 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
31810 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31811 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31812 This scanner type takes one option,
31813 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31814 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31815 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31816 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31817 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31818 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31821 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31822 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31824 If you omit the argument, the default path
31825 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31827 If you use a remote host,
31828 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31829 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31830 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31832 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31838 Only the first virus detected will be reported.
31841 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31842 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31843 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31844 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31845 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31848 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31853 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31854 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31855 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31856 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31857 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31859 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31860 a UNIX socket specification,
31861 a TCP socket specification,
31862 or a (global) option.
31864 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31865 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31866 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31867 and the second a port number,
31868 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31869 These per-server options are supported:
31871 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31874 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31875 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31877 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31881 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31882 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31883 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31884 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31885 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31887 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31889 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31890 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31891 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31892 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31894 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31895 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31896 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31897 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31898 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31899 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31900 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31901 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31902 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31904 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31905 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31906 (Connection refused)
31909 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31910 contributing the code for this scanner.
31913 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31914 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31915 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31916 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31919 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31920 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31923 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31924 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31925 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31926 the &"trigger"& expression.
31929 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31930 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31931 &"name"& expression.
31934 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31936 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31938 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31939 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31940 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31941 configuration setting:
31943 av_scanner = cmdline:\
31944 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31945 found in file:'(.+)'
31948 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31949 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31951 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31952 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31953 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31954 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31957 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31958 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31960 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31961 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31964 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31965 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31966 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31970 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
31972 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31974 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
31975 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
31976 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
31977 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
31980 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
31982 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31985 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
31986 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
31987 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
31989 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
31991 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
31992 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
31994 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
31995 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31996 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
31997 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
31998 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32001 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32003 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32006 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32007 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
32008 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
32009 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
32010 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32011 provided that mksd has
32012 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32014 av_scanner = mksd:2
32016 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32019 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32020 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32021 running on the local machine.
32022 There are four options:
32023 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32024 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32025 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32026 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32027 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32030 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32032 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32033 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32034 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32035 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32036 specify an empty element to get this.
32039 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32040 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32041 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
32042 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32043 client communication. For example:
32045 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32047 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32051 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32052 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32055 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32056 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32057 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32058 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32059 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32060 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32063 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32064 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32065 The first element can then be one of
32068 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32069 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32072 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32073 the condition fails immediately.
32075 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32076 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32077 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32078 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32079 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
32082 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32083 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32084 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32086 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32087 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32090 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32092 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32094 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32095 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32096 is set to record the actual address used.
32098 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32099 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32100 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32101 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32104 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32105 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32107 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32109 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32112 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32114 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32115 malware = */defer_ok
32117 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32118 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32120 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32122 in the main Exim configuration.
32124 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32125 set acl_m0 = sophie
32128 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32129 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32134 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32135 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32136 .cindex "spam scanning"
32137 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32139 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32140 score and a report for the message.
32141 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32143 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32144 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32145 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
32147 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32149 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32151 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32152 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32155 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32156 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32157 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32158 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32159 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32160 configuration as follows (example):
32162 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
32164 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32165 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32166 iptables firewall, consider setting
32167 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32168 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32169 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32170 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32174 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32176 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32178 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32181 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32182 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32183 file name instead of an address/port pair:
32185 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32187 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32188 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32189 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32190 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
32192 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32193 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32196 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32197 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32198 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32201 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32202 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32203 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
32205 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32206 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32207 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32208 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32210 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32212 The supported options are:
32214 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32215 weight=<value> Selection bias
32216 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32217 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32218 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32219 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32222 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32223 higher values being tried first.
32224 The default priority is 1.
32226 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32227 Within a priority set
32228 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32229 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32231 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32232 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32233 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32234 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32236 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32237 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32239 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32240 The default value is two minutes.
32242 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32243 a failed connect is made.
32244 The default is to not retry.
32246 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32247 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32248 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32251 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32252 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32253 is set to record the actual address used.
32255 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32256 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32258 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32261 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32262 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32263 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32264 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32265 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32268 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32269 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32270 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32271 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32272 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32274 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32275 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32277 or the use of PRDR,
32278 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32279 are needed to use this feature.
32281 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32282 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32283 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32286 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32287 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32288 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32291 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32292 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32296 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32297 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32298 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32299 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32301 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32302 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32304 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32305 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32306 available for use at delivery time.
32309 .vitem &$spam_score$&
32310 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32311 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32313 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32314 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32315 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32316 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32317 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32319 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
32320 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32321 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32322 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32323 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32324 spam bar is 50 characters.
32326 .vitem &$spam_report$&
32327 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32328 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32329 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32330 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32331 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32332 unencoded in headers.
32334 .vitem &$spam_action$&
32335 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32336 spam score versus threshold.
32337 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32341 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32342 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32343 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32345 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32346 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32347 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32348 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32349 spam condition, like this:
32351 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32352 spam = joe/defer_ok
32354 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32356 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32359 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32360 warn spam = nobody:true
32361 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32362 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32364 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32365 # is over threshold
32367 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32369 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32370 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32372 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32377 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32378 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32379 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
32380 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32381 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32382 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32383 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32384 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32385 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32386 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32389 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32390 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32391 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32392 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32393 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32394 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32395 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32397 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32398 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32399 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32400 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32401 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32403 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32404 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32405 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32406 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32407 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32410 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32412 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32416 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32418 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32419 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32420 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32421 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32423 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32424 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32425 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32426 the full path and file name.
32428 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32429 filename, and the default path is then used.
32431 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32432 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32433 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32435 decode = $mime_filename
32437 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32438 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32439 automatically unlinked.
32441 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32442 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32443 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32444 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32445 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32447 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32448 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32449 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32451 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32452 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32453 available in the MIME ACL:
32456 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32457 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32458 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32459 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32460 contains the empty string.
32462 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32463 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32464 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32470 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32471 case-insensitively.
32473 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32474 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32475 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32476 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32477 only used for display purposes.
32479 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32480 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32481 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32483 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32484 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32485 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32487 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32488 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32489 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32490 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32491 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32493 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32494 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32495 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32496 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32498 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32499 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32500 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32501 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32505 application/octet-stream
32509 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32512 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32513 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32514 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32515 containing the decoded data.
32520 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32521 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32522 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32523 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32526 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32528 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32530 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32531 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32532 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32533 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32535 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32536 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32540 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32543 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32544 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32547 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32548 and the rest are attachments.
32551 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32554 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32555 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32556 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32558 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32559 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32560 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32561 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32563 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32564 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32565 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32566 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32567 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32569 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32570 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32571 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32572 decoding is fully recursive.
32574 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32575 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32576 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32577 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32578 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32579 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32580 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32585 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32586 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32587 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32588 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32589 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32591 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32592 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32593 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32594 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32595 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32597 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32598 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32599 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32600 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32601 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32602 32K characters are checked.
32604 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32605 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32606 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32607 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32608 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32610 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32611 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32613 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32614 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32615 matching regular expression.
32616 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32617 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32619 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32627 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32630 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32631 "Local scan function"
32632 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32633 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32634 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32635 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32636 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32638 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32639 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32640 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32641 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32642 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32644 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32645 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32646 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32647 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32649 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32650 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32651 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32652 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32654 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32655 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32656 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32657 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32658 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32659 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32660 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32661 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32662 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32666 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32667 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32668 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32669 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32670 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32671 directory, so you might set
32673 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32675 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32676 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32677 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32678 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32679 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32680 _src/local_scan.c_.
32682 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32683 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32685 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32687 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32692 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32693 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32694 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32696 #include "local_scan.h"
32698 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32699 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32700 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32701 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32702 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32703 strings and pointers to character strings:
32705 #define CS (char *)
32706 #define CCS (const char *)
32707 #define CSS (char **)
32708 #define US (unsigned char *)
32709 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32710 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32712 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32714 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32716 The arguments are as follows:
32719 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32720 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32721 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32723 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32724 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32725 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32726 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32727 case this changes in some future version.
32729 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32730 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32733 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32736 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32737 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32738 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32739 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32740 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32741 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32743 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32744 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32745 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32747 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32748 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32749 queued without immediate delivery.
32751 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32752 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32753 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32754 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32755 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32758 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32759 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32760 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32763 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32764 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32765 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32766 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32767 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32768 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32769 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32771 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32772 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32773 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32776 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32777 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32778 &%-oe%& command line options.
32782 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32783 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32784 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32785 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32786 want to do this, you must have the line
32788 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32790 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32791 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32792 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32795 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32796 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32797 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32798 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32799 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32800 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32802 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32803 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32805 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32806 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32807 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32810 int local_scan_options_count =
32811 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32813 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32814 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32818 my_string = some string of text...
32820 The available types of option data are as follows:
32823 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32824 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32825 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32826 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32827 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32828 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32831 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32832 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32833 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32834 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32837 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32838 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32841 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32842 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32843 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32844 printed with the suffix K or M.
32846 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32847 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32848 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32849 always output in octal.
32851 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32852 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32853 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32855 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32856 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32857 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32860 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32861 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32865 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32866 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32867 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32868 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32869 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32870 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32871 C variables are as follows:
32874 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32875 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32876 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32878 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32879 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32880 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32882 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32883 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32884 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32885 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32888 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32889 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32890 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32893 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32894 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32898 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32899 selected, you should use code like this:
32901 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32902 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32904 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32905 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32906 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32908 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32909 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32912 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32913 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32915 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32916 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32918 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32919 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32920 &%-bh%& command line option.
32922 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32923 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32924 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32926 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32927 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32928 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32929 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32931 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32932 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32933 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32935 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32936 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32938 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32939 The number of accepted recipients.
32941 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32942 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32943 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32944 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32945 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32946 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32947 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32948 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32949 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32950 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32951 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32952 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32954 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32955 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32957 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32958 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32959 locally-submitted messages.
32961 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32962 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32963 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32965 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32966 The name of the sending host, if known.
32968 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32969 The port on the sending host.
32971 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32972 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32974 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32975 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32977 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32978 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32979 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32983 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32984 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32985 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32986 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32991 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32992 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32994 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32995 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32996 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32997 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32998 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32999 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33000 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33002 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33003 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33006 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33007 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33008 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33013 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33014 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33017 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33018 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33020 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33021 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33022 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33023 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33025 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33026 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33027 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33028 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33029 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33030 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33031 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33032 is NULL for all recipients.
33037 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33038 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33039 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33040 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33044 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33045 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33047 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33048 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33049 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33050 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33052 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33053 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33054 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33055 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33056 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33058 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33060 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33061 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33062 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33063 return value is as follows:
33068 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33074 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33080 The process timed out.
33084 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33087 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33088 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33089 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33090 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33091 forks a subprocess that is running
33093 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33095 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33096 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33097 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33098 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33100 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33101 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33102 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33103 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33106 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33107 *sender_authentication)*&
33108 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33111 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33113 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33116 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33117 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33118 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33119 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33120 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33122 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33123 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33126 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33127 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33128 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33129 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33130 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33131 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33132 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33133 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33135 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33136 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33137 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33138 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33139 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33140 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33142 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33143 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33144 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33145 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33147 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33148 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33149 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33150 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33151 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33152 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33153 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33154 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33155 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33156 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33158 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33159 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33161 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33162 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33165 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33166 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33167 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33168 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33169 match the specification, the function does nothing.
33172 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33173 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33174 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33175 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33176 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33177 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33179 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33181 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33182 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33183 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33184 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33185 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33188 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33189 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33190 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33191 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33192 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33193 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33194 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33195 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33197 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33198 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33199 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33201 &`OK `& match succeeded
33202 &`FAIL `& match failed
33203 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33205 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33206 inability to contact a database.
33208 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33210 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33211 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33212 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33214 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33216 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33217 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33218 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33220 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33222 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33225 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33227 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33228 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33229 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33230 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33231 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33232 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33235 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33237 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33238 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33239 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33240 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33241 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33242 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33245 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33246 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33247 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33248 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33250 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33251 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33252 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33253 value afterwards. For example:
33255 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33256 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33257 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33260 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33261 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33262 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33263 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33270 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33271 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33272 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33273 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33274 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33275 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33276 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33277 binary string is returned with an error message.
33279 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33280 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33281 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33283 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33284 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33285 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33286 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33287 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33289 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33290 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33291 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33293 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33294 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33295 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33296 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33300 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33301 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33304 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33305 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33306 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33307 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33308 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33309 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33310 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33311 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33314 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33315 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33317 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33318 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33319 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33320 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33321 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33322 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33323 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33325 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33326 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33328 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33329 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33330 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33331 multiple output lines.
33333 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33334 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33335 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33336 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33337 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33338 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33339 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33342 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33343 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33344 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33345 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33347 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33348 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33349 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33351 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33354 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33357 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33358 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33359 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33360 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33361 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33362 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33368 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33369 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33370 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33371 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33372 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33373 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33374 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33377 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33378 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33379 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33380 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33382 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33383 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33385 store_pool = POOL_PERM
33387 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33388 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33389 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33390 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33392 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33393 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33394 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33395 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33402 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33403 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33405 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33406 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33407 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33408 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33409 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33410 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33411 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33412 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33414 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33415 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33416 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33417 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33418 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33420 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33421 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33422 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33423 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33424 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33425 prevent it happening on retries.
33427 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33428 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33429 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33430 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33431 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33432 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33433 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33434 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33437 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33438 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33439 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33440 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33441 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33442 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33443 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33445 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33446 system_filter_user = exim
33448 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33449 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33450 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33451 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33452 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33453 by the &%reply%& command.
33456 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33457 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33458 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33459 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33461 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33462 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33466 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33467 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33468 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33469 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33470 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33471 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33474 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33475 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33476 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33477 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33478 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33479 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33480 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33482 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33483 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33484 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33485 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33486 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33488 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33489 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33490 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33491 to which users' filter files can refer.
33495 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33496 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33497 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33498 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33499 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33503 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33504 .cindex "freezing messages"
33505 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33506 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33507 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33508 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33509 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33510 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33511 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33512 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33513 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33514 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33516 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33518 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33520 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33521 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33522 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33523 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33524 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33527 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33528 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33529 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33530 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33532 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33533 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33534 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33535 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33536 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33537 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33538 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33539 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33540 message. For example:
33542 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33543 because it contains attachments that we are \
33544 not prepared to receive."
33547 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33548 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33549 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33550 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33551 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33552 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33555 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33556 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33558 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33559 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33560 generated by the filter.
33562 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33564 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33565 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33571 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33572 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33577 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33578 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33579 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33580 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33581 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33583 headers add <string>
33584 headers remove <string>
33586 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33587 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33588 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33589 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33590 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33592 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33593 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33594 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33597 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33598 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33601 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33602 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33603 space after input continuations is ignored.
33605 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33606 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33607 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33608 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33609 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33611 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33612 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33613 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33614 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33615 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33616 used for all recipients of the message.
33618 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33619 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33620 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33621 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33622 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33623 until the message is actually being written (see section
33624 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33626 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33627 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33628 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33629 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33630 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33631 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33632 modified more than once.
33634 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33635 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33638 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33639 headers remove "Subject"
33640 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33641 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33646 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33647 .cindex "envelope sender"
33648 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33650 errors_to <some address>
33652 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33653 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33654 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33657 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33659 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33660 address if its delivery failed.
33664 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33665 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33666 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33667 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33668 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33669 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33670 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33671 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33672 which implements such a filter:
33677 domains = +local_domains
33678 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33683 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33684 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33685 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33686 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33688 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33689 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33690 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33691 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33693 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33694 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33695 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33702 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33703 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33705 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33706 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33707 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33708 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33709 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33710 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33711 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33712 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33714 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33715 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33716 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33717 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33718 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33720 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33721 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33722 loopback interface specially in any way.
33724 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33725 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33730 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33731 .cindex "message" "submission"
33732 .cindex "submission mode"
33733 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33734 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33735 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33736 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33738 control = submission
33740 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33741 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33742 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33743 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33744 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33745 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33747 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33748 control = submission
33750 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33751 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33752 is used to separate options. For example:
33754 control = submission/sender_retain
33756 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33757 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33758 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33759 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33760 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33761 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33762 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33764 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33765 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33768 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33770 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33771 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33772 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33773 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33775 accept authenticated = *
33776 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33777 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33778 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33780 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33781 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33782 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33784 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33786 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33789 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33791 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33792 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33793 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33794 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33796 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33797 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33798 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33799 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33800 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33801 spoof another's address.
33803 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33804 .cindex "line endings"
33805 .cindex "carriage return"
33807 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33808 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33809 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33810 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33811 use CRLF or just CR.
33813 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33814 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33815 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33816 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33817 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33818 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33819 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33820 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33824 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33826 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33829 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33830 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33833 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33834 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33835 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33836 people trying to play silly games.
33838 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33839 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33847 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33848 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33849 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33850 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33851 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33852 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33853 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33854 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33856 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33857 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33858 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33859 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33860 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33862 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33863 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33864 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33865 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33866 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33867 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33868 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33869 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33874 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33875 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33876 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33877 .cindex "sender" "address"
33878 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33879 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33880 .cindex "envelope sender"
33881 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33882 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33883 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33884 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33886 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33887 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33889 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33890 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33891 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33892 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33893 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33894 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33895 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33896 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33897 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33899 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33900 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33901 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33902 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33903 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33904 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33905 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33907 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33908 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33909 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33911 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33912 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33913 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33914 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33918 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33919 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33920 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
33921 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33922 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33923 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33924 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33925 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33928 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33929 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33932 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33933 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33937 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33938 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33940 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33941 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33942 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33944 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33947 For a locally-submitted message,
33948 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33949 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33950 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33951 included in log lines in this case.
33953 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33954 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33960 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33961 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33962 includes the header line:
33964 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33967 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33968 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33969 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33970 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33971 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33972 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33975 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33976 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33977 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
33978 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33979 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33980 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33982 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33983 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33984 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33985 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33986 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33987 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33988 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33989 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33993 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33994 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33995 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
33996 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33997 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33998 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33999 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34000 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34001 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34005 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34006 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34007 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34008 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34009 .cindex "message" "submission"
34010 .cindex "submission mode"
34011 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34012 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34015 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34016 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34018 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34019 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34021 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34022 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34023 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34025 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34026 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34028 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34029 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34033 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34035 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34036 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34037 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34038 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34039 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34040 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34041 &%qualify_domain%&.
34043 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34044 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34045 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34046 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34049 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34050 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34051 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34052 .cindex "message" "submission"
34053 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34054 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34055 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34056 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34057 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34058 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34059 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34060 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34061 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34062 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34065 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34066 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34067 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34068 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34069 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34070 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34072 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34073 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34074 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34075 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34077 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34078 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34079 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34082 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34083 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34084 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34085 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34086 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34087 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34088 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34089 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34090 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34091 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34092 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34093 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34097 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34098 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34099 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34100 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34101 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34102 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34103 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34104 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34105 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34109 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34110 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34111 .cindex "message" "submission"
34112 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34113 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34114 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34115 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34116 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34119 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34120 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34121 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34122 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34123 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34124 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34125 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34126 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34127 line is added to the message.
34129 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34130 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34131 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34132 options true at the same time.
34134 .cindex "submission mode"
34135 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34136 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34137 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34138 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34140 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34141 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34142 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34143 created as follows:
34146 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34147 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34148 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34150 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34151 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34153 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34154 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34157 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34158 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34159 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34160 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34162 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34163 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34164 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34165 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34169 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34170 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34171 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34172 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34173 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34174 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34175 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34176 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34177 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34179 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34180 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34181 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34182 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34183 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34184 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34186 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34187 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34188 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34190 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34191 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34192 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34194 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34195 X-added-second: another added header line
34197 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34199 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34200 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34201 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34203 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34204 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34205 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34206 not part of the names. For example:
34208 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34211 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34212 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34213 Each item is separately expanded.
34214 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34215 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34216 will act as list separators.
34218 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34219 items are expanded at routing time,
34220 and then associated with all addresses that are
34221 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34222 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34223 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34225 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34226 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34227 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34228 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34230 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34231 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34232 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34235 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34236 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34237 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34238 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34239 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34240 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34241 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34243 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34244 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34245 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34246 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34248 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34249 the following consequences:
34252 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34253 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34254 to it, at all times.
34256 Header lines that are added by a router's
34257 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34258 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34260 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34261 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34263 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34264 a later router or by a transport.
34266 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34267 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34269 headers_remove = subject
34270 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34274 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34275 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34281 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34282 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34283 .cindex "constructed address"
34284 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34287 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34291 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34293 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34294 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34295 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34296 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34297 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34298 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34299 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34300 there is no password file entry.
34303 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34304 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34305 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34306 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34307 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34308 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34309 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34310 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34314 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34315 .cindex "case of local parts"
34316 .cindex "local part" "case of"
34317 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34318 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34319 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34320 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34321 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34322 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34325 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
34326 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34327 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34328 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34329 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34333 domains = +local_domains
34334 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34335 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34338 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34339 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34340 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34341 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34342 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34346 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34347 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
34348 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
34349 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34350 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34351 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34352 empty components for compatibility.
34356 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34357 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34358 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34359 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34360 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34361 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34363 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34364 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34365 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34366 example, a header such as
34370 might get rewritten as
34372 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34374 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34375 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34378 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34379 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34380 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34381 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34382 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34383 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34384 .ecindex IIDmesproc
34388 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34389 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34391 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34392 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34393 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34394 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34395 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34396 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34397 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34400 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34402 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34404 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34407 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34410 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34412 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34415 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34418 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34419 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34422 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34423 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34424 used to contain the envelope information.
34428 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34429 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34430 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34431 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34432 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34435 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34436 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34437 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34438 processing is the same in both cases.
34440 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34441 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34442 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34443 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34444 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34445 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34446 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34447 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34450 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34451 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34452 required for the transaction.
34454 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34455 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34456 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34457 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34458 is called for verification.
34460 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34461 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34462 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34464 .cindex "carriage return"
34466 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34467 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34468 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34471 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34472 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34473 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34474 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34475 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34476 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34477 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34478 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34479 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34481 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34482 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34483 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34484 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34486 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34487 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34488 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34489 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34491 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34492 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34493 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34494 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34495 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34496 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34497 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34498 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34499 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34500 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34502 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34503 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34505 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34506 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34507 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34508 square bracket of the IP address.
34513 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34514 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34515 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34516 .cindex "host" "error"
34517 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34518 message errors, and recipient errors.
34521 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34522 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34523 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34526 Connection refused or timed out,
34528 Any error response code on connection,
34530 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34532 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34534 I/O errors at any time,
34536 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34537 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34540 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34541 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34542 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34543 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34544 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34545 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34546 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34547 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34549 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34550 .cindex "message" "error"
34551 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34552 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34553 message errors are:
34556 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34559 Timeout after MAIL,
34561 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34562 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34563 connection at any other time.
34566 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34567 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34568 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34569 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34570 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34571 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34572 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34573 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34574 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34575 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34577 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34578 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34579 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34582 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34583 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34584 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34585 recipient errors are:
34588 Any error response to RCPT,
34590 Timeout after RCPT.
34593 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34594 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34595 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34596 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34597 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34598 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34599 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34600 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34601 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34602 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34603 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34604 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34605 the retry clock is reset.
34607 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34608 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34609 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34610 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34611 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34612 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34613 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34614 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34615 recipient's retry time.
34618 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34619 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34620 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34621 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34622 until the next delivery attempt.
34624 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34625 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34626 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34627 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34628 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34631 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34632 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34633 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34634 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34635 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34636 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34637 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34639 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34640 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34641 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34642 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34643 then to be treated as a host error.
34645 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34646 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34647 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34648 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34649 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34654 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34655 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34656 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34659 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34660 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34661 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34663 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34665 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34666 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34667 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34668 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34669 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34670 stream and exits with an error code.
34672 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34673 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34674 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34675 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34677 .cindex "carriage return"
34679 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34680 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34681 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34683 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34684 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34685 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34687 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34688 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34689 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34690 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34691 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34692 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34693 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34694 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34696 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34697 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34698 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34699 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34700 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34701 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34702 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34703 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34704 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34706 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34707 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34708 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34710 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34711 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34712 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34713 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34714 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34716 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34717 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34718 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34719 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34720 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34721 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34722 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34724 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34725 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34726 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34727 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34728 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34730 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34731 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34732 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34733 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34734 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34735 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34736 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34737 a delivery process.
34739 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34740 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34741 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34742 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34743 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34745 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34746 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34747 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34748 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34750 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34751 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34752 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34756 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34757 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34758 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34759 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34760 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34761 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34762 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34763 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34766 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34767 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34768 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34769 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34770 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34771 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34772 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34773 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34774 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34775 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34776 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34780 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34781 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34782 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34783 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34784 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34785 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34786 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34787 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34789 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34790 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34791 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34792 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34793 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34796 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34797 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34798 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34800 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34801 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34802 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34803 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34804 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34809 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34810 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34811 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34812 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34814 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34815 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34816 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34817 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34818 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34819 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34820 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34821 SMTP response codes.
34823 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34824 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34825 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34826 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34827 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34828 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34829 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34830 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34835 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34836 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34837 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34838 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34839 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34840 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34841 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34843 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34844 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34845 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34846 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34847 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34848 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34849 argument. For example,
34857 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34858 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34859 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34860 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34861 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34863 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34864 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34865 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34866 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34867 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34868 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34869 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34870 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34872 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34873 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34874 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34875 whatever the form of its argument. For
34878 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34879 $sender_host_address
34881 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34882 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34883 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34884 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34885 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34886 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34887 for it to change them before running the command.
34891 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34892 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34893 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34894 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34895 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34896 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34897 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34898 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34899 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34900 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34901 runs for RCPT commands:
34905 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34909 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34910 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34911 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34912 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34913 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34914 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34915 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34916 envelope along with the message.
34918 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34919 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34920 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34921 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34922 can be used to specify it.
34924 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34925 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34926 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34927 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34928 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34931 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34932 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34933 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34938 driver = manualroute
34939 transport = smtp_appendfile
34940 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34944 driver = appendfile
34945 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34950 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34951 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34952 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34956 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34957 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34958 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34959 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34960 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34961 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34962 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34963 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34964 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34965 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34967 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34968 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34970 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34971 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34972 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34973 make some use of automatically, for example:
34975 554 Unexpected end of file
34976 Transaction started in line 10
34977 Error detected in line 14
34979 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34982 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34983 The error message was:
34985 501 '>' missing at end of address
34987 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34988 The error was detected in line 12.
34989 The SMTP command at fault was:
34991 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34993 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34994 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34996 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34997 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34999 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35000 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35004 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35005 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35007 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35008 "Customizing messages"
35009 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
35010 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35011 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35012 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35013 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35015 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35016 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35017 option. Exim also adds the line
35019 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35021 to all warning and bounce messages,
35024 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35025 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35026 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35027 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35028 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35029 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35030 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35032 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35033 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35034 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35035 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35036 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35039 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35040 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35041 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35042 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35043 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35044 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35045 option, rounded to a whole number.
35047 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35050 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35051 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35053 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35054 failing addresses with their error messages.
35056 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35057 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35059 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35060 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35063 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35064 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35065 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35067 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35068 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35069 {: returning message to sender}}
35071 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35073 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35074 {that you sent }{sent by
35078 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35079 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35081 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35083 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35086 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35088 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35091 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35092 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35093 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35094 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35095 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35099 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35100 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35102 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35103 the delayed addresses.
35105 The third item then ends the message.
35108 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35109 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35111 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35112 $warn_message_delay
35114 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35116 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35117 {that you sent }{sent by
35121 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35122 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
35124 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35125 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35126 The date of the message is: $h_date
35128 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35130 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35131 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35132 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35133 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35134 the message will be returned to you.
35136 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35137 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35138 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35139 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35140 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35141 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35142 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35143 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35149 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35150 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35152 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35153 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35154 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35158 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35159 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35160 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35161 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35162 routing explicitly:
35164 send_to_smart_host:
35165 driver = manualroute
35166 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35167 transport = remote_smtp
35169 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35170 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35171 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35172 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35173 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35178 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35179 .cindex "mailing lists"
35180 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35181 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35182 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35184 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35185 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35186 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35187 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35191 domains = lists.example
35192 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35195 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35198 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35199 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35200 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35201 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35203 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35204 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35207 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35208 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35209 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35210 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35211 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35213 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35214 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35215 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35216 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35217 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35218 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35219 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35220 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35221 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35225 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35226 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35227 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35228 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35229 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35230 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35231 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35233 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35234 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35235 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35236 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35237 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35241 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35242 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35243 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35244 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35245 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35246 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35247 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35248 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35249 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35250 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35252 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35253 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35254 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35255 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35256 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35257 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35258 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35259 pre-existing messages.
35261 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35262 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35263 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35264 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35265 one level of expansion anyway.
35269 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35270 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35271 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35272 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35273 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35274 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35276 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35277 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35281 domains = lists.example
35282 local_part_suffix = -request
35283 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35288 domains = lists.example
35289 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35290 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35291 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35294 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35299 domains = lists.example
35301 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35303 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35304 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35305 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35308 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35309 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35310 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35311 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35312 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35313 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35314 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35315 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35316 &"unrouteable address"& error.
35318 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35319 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35320 the address, giving a suitable error message.
35325 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35327 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35328 .cindex "envelope sender"
35329 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35330 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35331 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35332 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35333 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35334 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35336 .oindex &%errors_to%&
35337 .oindex &%return_path%&
35338 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35339 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35340 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35341 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35342 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35343 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35344 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35350 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35351 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35353 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35354 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35355 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35356 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35357 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35358 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35359 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35362 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35364 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35365 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35366 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35367 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35368 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35369 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35371 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35372 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35373 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35374 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35378 domains = ! +local_domains
35380 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35381 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35384 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35385 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35386 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35387 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35390 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35391 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35392 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35393 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35394 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35398 domains = ! +local_domains
35399 transport = remote_smtp
35401 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35402 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35405 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35406 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35407 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35408 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35411 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35412 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35413 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35414 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35415 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35416 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35424 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35425 .cindex "virtual domains"
35426 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35427 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35431 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35432 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35433 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35435 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35436 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35437 have login accounts on that host.
35440 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35441 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35442 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35443 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35444 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35445 to a router of this form:
35449 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35450 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35453 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35454 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35455 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35456 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35457 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35458 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35460 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35461 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35462 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35463 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35465 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35466 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35467 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35471 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35472 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35473 transport = my_mailboxes
35475 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35476 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35477 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35478 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35479 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35483 driver = appendfile
35484 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35487 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35488 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35490 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35491 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35492 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35493 information about the domains.
35497 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35498 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35499 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35500 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35501 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35502 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35503 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35504 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35505 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35506 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35507 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35508 example, consider this router:
35513 file = $home/.forward
35514 local_part_suffix = -*
35515 local_part_suffix_optional
35518 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35519 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35520 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35521 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35523 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35524 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35527 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35528 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35529 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35530 control over which suffixes are valid.
35532 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35533 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35539 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35540 local_part_suffix = -*
35541 local_part_suffix_optional
35544 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35545 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35546 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35547 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35548 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35552 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35553 .cindex "vacation processing"
35554 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35555 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35556 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35557 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35558 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35561 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35562 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35563 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35564 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35566 spqr, vacation-spqr
35569 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35570 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35571 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35572 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35573 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35577 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35578 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35582 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35583 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35584 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35585 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35586 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35587 each day's messages.
35589 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35590 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35591 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35592 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35596 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35597 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35598 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35599 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35600 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35601 permanently connected.
35603 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35604 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35605 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35608 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35609 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35610 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35611 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35612 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35613 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35614 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35615 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35617 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35618 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35619 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35620 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35621 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35622 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35625 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35626 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35627 intermittent host. For example:
35629 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35631 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35632 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35633 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35634 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35635 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35636 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35639 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35640 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35641 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35642 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35643 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35644 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35645 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35649 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35650 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35651 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35652 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35653 delivered immediately.
35655 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35656 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35657 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35658 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35659 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35660 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35661 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35662 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35663 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35664 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35665 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35666 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35667 single SMTP connection.
35671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35674 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35675 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35676 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35677 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35678 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35679 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35680 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35681 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35682 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35683 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35686 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35687 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35688 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35689 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35690 email is not desirable.
35692 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35693 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35694 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35695 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35696 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35697 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35698 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35700 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35701 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35702 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35703 before sending a message to the smart host.
35705 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35706 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35707 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35709 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35710 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35711 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35712 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35713 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35714 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35715 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35717 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35721 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35722 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35724 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35725 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35726 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35727 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35728 successful, a zero return code is given.
35730 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35731 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35732 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35733 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35734 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35737 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35738 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35739 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35741 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35742 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35743 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35744 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35745 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35747 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35748 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35749 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35751 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35752 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35753 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35754 are ever generated.
35756 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35758 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35759 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35760 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35763 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35764 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35765 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35766 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35767 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35768 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35773 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35774 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35776 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35777 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35778 .cindex "log" "types of"
35779 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35784 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35785 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35786 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35787 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35788 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35789 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35790 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35791 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35793 .cindex "reject log"
35794 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35795 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35796 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35797 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35798 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35799 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35800 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35801 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35802 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35805 .cindex "panic log"
35806 .cindex "system log"
35807 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35808 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35809 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35810 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35811 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35812 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35813 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35814 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35815 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35818 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35819 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35820 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35822 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35825 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35826 ways of changing this:
35829 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35834 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35836 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35839 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35843 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35844 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35845 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35846 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35847 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35848 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35853 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35854 .cindex "log" "destination"
35855 .cindex "log" "to file"
35856 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35858 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35859 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35860 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35861 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35862 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35863 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35864 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35866 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35867 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35868 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35869 references to the host name:
35871 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35873 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35874 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35875 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35876 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35877 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35880 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35881 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35882 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35883 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35884 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35885 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35886 implying the use of a default path.
35888 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35889 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35890 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35891 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35892 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35893 equivalent to the setting:
35895 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35897 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35898 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35899 that is where the logs are written.
35901 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35902 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35904 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35906 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35907 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35908 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35909 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35911 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35916 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35917 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35918 .cindex "cycling logs"
35919 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35920 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35921 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35922 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35923 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35924 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35925 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35927 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35928 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35929 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35930 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35931 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35932 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35933 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35934 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35935 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35936 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35937 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35942 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35943 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35944 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35945 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35946 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35947 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35948 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35949 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35951 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35952 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35953 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35954 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35956 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35957 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35959 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35960 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35961 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35962 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35964 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35965 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35966 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35967 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35969 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35970 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35971 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35972 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35973 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35974 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35977 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35978 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35979 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35980 /var/log/exim/panic
35984 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35985 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35986 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35987 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35988 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35989 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35990 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35991 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35992 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35993 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35994 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35995 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35996 the time and host name to each line.
35997 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36000 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36002 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36004 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36007 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36008 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36009 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36010 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36012 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36013 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36014 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36015 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36016 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36017 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36018 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36019 RFC 3164, you should set
36021 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36023 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36024 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36026 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36027 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36028 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36029 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36030 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36031 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36032 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36033 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36034 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36036 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36037 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36038 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36039 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36042 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36045 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36046 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36047 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36048 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36050 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36051 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36052 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36053 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36054 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36055 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36057 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36058 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36059 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36062 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36064 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36065 without modification.
36067 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36068 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36069 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36074 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36075 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36076 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36077 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36078 timestamp. The flags are:
36080 &`<=`& message arrival
36081 &`(=`& message fakereject
36082 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36083 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36084 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36085 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36086 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36087 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36091 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36092 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36093 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36094 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36095 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36097 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36098 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36099 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36101 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36102 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36103 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36107 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36111 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36112 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36113 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36114 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36115 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36116 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36117 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36118 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36119 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36120 name in parentheses.
36122 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36123 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36124 the log containing text like these examples:
36126 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36127 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36129 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36132 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36133 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36136 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36137 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36138 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36139 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36140 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36141 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36142 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36143 suite that was used.
36145 .cindex log protocol
36146 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36147 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36148 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36149 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36150 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36151 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36152 authenticator name.
36154 .cindex "size" "of message"
36155 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36156 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36157 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36158 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36161 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36162 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36166 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36167 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36168 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36169 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36170 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36171 to fit it on the page:
36173 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36174 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
36175 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36176 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36177 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36179 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36180 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36181 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36182 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36183 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36185 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36186 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36187 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36188 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36190 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36191 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36193 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36195 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36196 parentheses afterwards.
36198 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36199 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36200 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36201 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36202 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36203 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36204 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36205 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36206 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36207 TLS cipher information is still available.
36209 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36210 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36211 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36212 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36213 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36215 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36216 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36218 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36219 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36222 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36223 .cindex "discarded messages"
36224 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36225 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36226 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36227 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36229 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36230 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36232 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36233 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36235 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36236 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36240 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36241 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36243 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36244 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36246 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36247 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36248 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36250 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36251 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36253 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36254 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36255 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36259 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36260 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36261 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36262 following form is logged:
36264 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36265 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36267 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36268 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36270 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36271 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36272 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36273 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36274 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36276 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36277 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36278 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36279 flagged with &`**`&.
36283 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36284 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36285 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36286 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36287 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36291 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36294 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36296 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36297 at the end of its processing.
36302 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36303 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36304 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36305 the following table:
36307 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36308 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36309 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36310 &`CV `& certificate verification status
36311 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36312 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36313 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36314 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36315 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36316 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36317 &`H `& host name and IP address
36318 &`I `& local interface used
36319 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36320 &`id `& message id for incoming message
36321 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36322 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36323 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36324 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36325 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36326 &`Q `& alternate queue name
36327 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36328 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36329 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36330 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36331 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
36332 &`S `& size of message in bytes
36333 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36334 &`ST `& shadow transport name
36335 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36336 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36337 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36338 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36339 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
36343 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36344 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36345 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36348 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36349 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36350 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36351 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36352 during the first delivery attempt.
36354 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36355 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36356 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36358 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36359 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36360 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36361 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36362 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36365 .cindex "error" "ignored"
36366 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36369 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36370 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36372 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36373 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36375 A delivery set up by a router configured with
36376 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36377 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36381 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36385 .cindex DKIM "log line"
36386 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
36387 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
36395 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36396 .cindex "log" "selectors"
36397 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36398 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36399 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36402 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36404 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36405 selection marked by asterisks:
36407 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36408 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36409 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36410 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36411 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36412 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36413 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36414 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36415 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36416 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
36417 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
36418 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36419 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36420 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36421 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36422 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36423 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36424 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36425 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36426 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
36427 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36428 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36429 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36430 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36431 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36432 &` pid `& Exim process id
36433 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36434 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36435 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36436 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36437 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36438 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36439 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36440 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36441 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36442 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36443 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36444 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36445 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36446 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36447 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36448 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36449 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36450 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36451 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36452 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36453 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36454 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36455 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36457 &` all `& all of the above
36459 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36460 section &<<SECID99>>&
36462 More details on each of these items follows:
36466 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36467 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36468 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36469 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36470 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36471 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36473 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36474 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36475 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36476 this log selector is set.
36478 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36479 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36480 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36481 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36482 such users cannot access the log).
36484 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36485 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36486 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36487 parentheses between them.
36489 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36490 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36491 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36492 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36493 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36494 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36495 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36496 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36497 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36498 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36499 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36500 between the caller and Exim.
36502 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36503 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36504 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36506 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36507 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36508 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36509 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36510 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36511 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36513 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36514 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36515 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36516 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36517 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
36519 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36520 .cindex "size" "of message"
36521 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36522 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36525 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36526 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36527 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
36528 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
36530 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36531 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36532 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
36535 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36536 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36537 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36538 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36539 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36542 .cindex dnssec logging
36543 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36544 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36545 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36546 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36547 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36549 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36550 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36551 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36552 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36553 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36554 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36556 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36557 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36558 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36559 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36560 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36562 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36563 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36564 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36565 client's ident port times out.
36567 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36568 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36569 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36570 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36571 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36572 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36573 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36574 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36575 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36576 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36577 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36579 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36580 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36581 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36582 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36583 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36584 on a proxied connection
36585 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36586 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36588 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36589 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36590 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36591 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36592 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36593 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36594 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36595 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36596 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36597 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36598 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36600 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36601 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36602 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36604 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36605 .cindex millisecond logging
36606 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
36607 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36608 appended to the seconds value.
36610 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36611 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36612 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36613 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36614 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36615 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36616 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36617 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36618 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36620 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36621 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
36622 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36623 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36624 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36625 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36626 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36627 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36628 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36629 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36631 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36632 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36633 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36634 immediately after the time and date.
36636 .cindex "log" "queue run"
36637 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36638 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36640 .cindex "log" "queue time"
36641 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36642 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36643 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36644 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36645 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36646 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36647 message has been successfully received.
36648 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36649 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36651 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36652 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36653 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36654 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36657 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
36658 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
36659 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
36660 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36661 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
36664 .cindex "log" "recipients"
36665 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36666 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36667 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36668 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36670 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36673 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
36674 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36675 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36676 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36678 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36679 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36680 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36681 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36682 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36684 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36685 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36686 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36687 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36690 .cindex "log" "return path"
36691 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36692 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36693 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36694 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36696 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36697 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36698 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36699 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36700 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36702 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36703 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36704 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36705 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36708 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36709 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36712 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36713 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36714 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36715 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36717 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36718 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36720 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36721 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36722 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36723 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36724 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36725 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36728 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36729 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36730 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36731 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36732 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36733 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36734 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36735 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36736 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36737 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36739 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36740 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36741 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36742 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36743 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36744 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36745 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36746 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36748 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36749 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36750 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36751 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36752 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36753 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36755 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36756 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36757 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36758 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36759 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36760 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36761 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36762 already have their own log lines.
36764 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36765 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36766 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36767 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36768 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36769 the same logging options.
36771 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36772 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36776 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36777 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36778 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36779 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36780 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36782 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36783 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36784 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36785 was accepted or used.
36787 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36788 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36789 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36790 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36791 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36792 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36793 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36794 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36796 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36797 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36798 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36799 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36800 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36801 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36802 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36803 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36804 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36806 .cindex "log" "subject"
36807 .cindex "subject, logging"
36808 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36809 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36810 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36811 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36812 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36814 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36816 .cindex DANE logging
36817 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36818 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36821 using a CA trust anchor,
36822 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
36824 and &`CV=no`& if not.
36826 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36827 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36828 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36829 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36831 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36832 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36833 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36834 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36835 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36837 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36838 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36839 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36840 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36841 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36843 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36844 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36845 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36849 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36850 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36851 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36852 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36853 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36854 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36855 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36856 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36857 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36858 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36859 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36860 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36861 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36863 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36864 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36865 &%message_logs%& option false.
36871 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36872 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36874 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36875 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36876 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36877 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36878 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36880 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36881 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36882 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36883 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36884 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36885 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36886 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36888 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36889 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36890 "extract statistics from the log"
36891 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36892 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36893 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36894 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36895 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36896 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36897 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36898 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36901 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36902 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36903 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36908 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36909 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36910 .cindex "process, querying"
36912 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36913 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36914 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36915 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36916 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36917 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36918 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36919 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36921 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36922 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36923 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36926 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36927 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36928 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36929 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36930 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36933 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36934 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36935 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36936 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36938 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36940 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
36941 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
36942 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36943 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
36944 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
36945 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36947 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36948 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36952 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36953 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36954 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
36955 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36959 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36963 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36964 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36966 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36967 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36970 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
36971 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36972 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
36976 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
36977 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36978 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
36980 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
36981 Match against the size field.
36983 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36984 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36986 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36987 Match messages that are older than the given time.
36990 Match only frozen messages.
36993 Match only non-frozen messages.
36996 The following options control the format of the output:
37000 Display only the count of matching messages.
37003 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37007 Display message ids only.
37010 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37013 Display messages in reverse order.
37016 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37019 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37023 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37024 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37025 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37026 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37027 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
37028 running a command such as
37030 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37032 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37033 it, as in the following example:
37035 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37037 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37038 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37039 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37040 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37042 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37043 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37044 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37045 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37046 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37047 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37050 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37051 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37052 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37053 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37054 level"& addresses).
37059 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37061 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37062 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37063 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37064 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37065 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37066 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37067 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37068 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37069 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37070 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37072 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37074 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37076 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37077 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37078 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
37080 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37081 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37082 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37083 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37084 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37086 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37087 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37088 regular expression.
37090 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37091 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37093 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37094 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37098 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37099 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37100 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37101 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37102 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37103 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37106 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37107 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37108 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37109 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37110 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37113 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37114 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37115 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37116 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37117 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37118 the &%--help%& option.
37121 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37122 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37123 .cindex "cycling logs"
37124 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37125 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37126 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37127 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37128 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37129 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37130 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37132 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37133 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37135 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37136 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37137 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37141 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37142 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37143 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37144 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37145 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37146 logs are handled similarly.
37148 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37149 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37150 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37151 any existing log files.
37153 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37154 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37155 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37156 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37157 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37159 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37161 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37162 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37166 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37167 .cindex "statistics"
37168 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37169 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37170 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37171 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
37172 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
37174 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37175 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37176 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37177 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37178 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37180 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37182 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37183 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37184 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37185 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37186 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37187 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37188 also produced per user.
37190 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37191 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37192 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37193 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37194 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37196 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37197 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37198 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37199 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37200 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37201 an entirely separate message.
37203 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37204 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37205 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37206 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37207 least one address that failed.
37209 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37210 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37211 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37212 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
37213 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37214 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37215 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37217 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37218 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37219 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37221 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37222 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37223 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37225 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37228 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37229 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37230 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37231 .cindex "checking access"
37232 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37233 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37234 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37235 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37236 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37237 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37239 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37240 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37242 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37244 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37245 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37246 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37247 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37250 550 Relay not permitted
37252 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37253 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37254 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37255 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37258 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37259 -f himself@there.example
37261 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37262 mandatory arguments.
37264 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37265 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37266 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37270 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37271 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37272 .cindex "building DBM files"
37273 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37274 .cindex "lower casing"
37275 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37276 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37277 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37278 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37279 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37280 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37282 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37283 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37284 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37285 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37288 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37289 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37290 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37294 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37295 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
37296 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
37297 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37299 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37301 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37302 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37304 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37305 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37306 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37307 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37308 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37309 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37311 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37312 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37313 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37314 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37315 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37316 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37317 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37323 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37324 .cindex "retry" "times"
37325 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
37326 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37327 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37328 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37329 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37330 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37331 output. For example:
37333 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37334 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37335 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37336 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37337 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37338 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37339 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37340 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37341 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37342 past final cutoff time
37344 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37345 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37346 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37347 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37348 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37349 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37352 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37353 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37354 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37355 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37356 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37357 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37361 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37362 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37363 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37364 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37365 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37366 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37367 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37370 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
37372 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37375 &'callout'&: the callout cache
37377 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37379 &'misc'&: other hints data
37382 The &'misc'& database is used for
37385 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37387 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37388 &(smtp)& transport)
37390 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37396 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37397 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37398 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37399 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37400 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37402 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37404 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37406 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
37407 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37409 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37410 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37411 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37412 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37413 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37414 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37415 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37416 and a textual description of the error.
37418 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37419 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37420 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37423 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37424 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37425 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37426 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37427 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37428 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37433 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37434 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37435 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37436 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37437 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37438 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37439 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37440 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37441 updated sufficiently often.
37443 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37444 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37445 the retry database:
37447 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37449 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37450 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37451 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37452 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37453 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37454 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37455 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37456 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37457 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37458 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37459 whenever it removes information from the database.
37461 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37462 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37463 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37464 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37465 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37467 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37468 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37469 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37470 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37471 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37472 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37473 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37476 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37477 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37482 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37483 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37484 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37485 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37486 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37487 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37488 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37491 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37492 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37493 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37494 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37495 by new data, for example:
37499 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37500 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37501 used as optional separators.
37506 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37507 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37508 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37509 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37510 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37511 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37512 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37513 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37514 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37515 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37516 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37517 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37518 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37522 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37525 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37528 .vitem &%-interval%&
37529 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37530 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37532 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37533 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37536 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37539 Suppress verification output.
37541 .vitem &%-retries%&
37542 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37543 the lock (default 10).
37545 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37546 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37547 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37548 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37551 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37552 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37553 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37554 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37557 Generate verbose output.
37560 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37561 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37562 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37563 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37564 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37565 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37566 more than 30 minutes old.
37568 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37569 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37570 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37571 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37572 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37573 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37575 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37576 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37577 suppresses all output except error messages.
37581 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37583 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37585 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37586 <&'some commands'&>
37589 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37590 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37593 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37594 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37596 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37597 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37602 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37604 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37605 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37606 .cindex "X-windows"
37607 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37608 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37609 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37610 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37611 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37612 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37613 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37614 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37618 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37619 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37620 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37621 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37622 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37623 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37624 parameters are for.
37626 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37627 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37628 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37630 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37632 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37633 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37634 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37635 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37636 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37638 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37639 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37641 Eximon*background: gray94
37643 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37644 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37645 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37646 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37647 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37648 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37649 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37652 Eximon*highlight: gray
37655 .cindex "admin user"
37656 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37657 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37659 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37660 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37661 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37662 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37663 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37665 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37666 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37667 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37668 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37669 different parts of the display.
37674 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37675 .cindex "stripchart"
37676 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37677 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37678 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37679 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37680 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37681 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37682 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37683 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37684 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37686 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37687 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37688 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37689 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37691 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37692 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37693 to a single partition.
37695 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37696 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37697 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37698 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37699 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37700 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37701 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37706 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37707 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37708 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37709 .cindex "window size"
37710 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37711 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37712 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37713 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37714 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37715 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37717 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37718 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37719 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37720 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37722 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37723 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37724 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37725 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37726 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37727 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37729 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37730 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37731 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37735 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37736 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37737 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37738 the main log is maintained.
37739 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37740 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37741 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37742 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37743 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37745 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37746 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37747 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37748 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37749 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37750 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37751 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37752 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37753 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37754 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37755 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37757 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37758 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37759 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37760 It cannot go further back up the log.
37762 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37763 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37764 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37765 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37766 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37767 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37769 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37770 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37771 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37772 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37773 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37774 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37776 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37777 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37778 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37779 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37780 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37781 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37782 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37783 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37784 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37789 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37790 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37791 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37792 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37793 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37794 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37795 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37796 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37797 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37798 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37800 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37801 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37802 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37803 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37804 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37805 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37806 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37808 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37809 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37810 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37811 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37812 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37813 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37814 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37816 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37817 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37818 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37819 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37821 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37822 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37823 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37824 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37825 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37826 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37827 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37830 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37831 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37833 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37834 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37835 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37836 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37837 display is updated.
37841 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37842 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37843 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37844 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37845 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37848 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37849 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37850 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37851 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37852 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37854 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37856 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37860 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37861 in a new text window.
37863 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37864 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37865 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37867 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37868 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37869 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37870 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37872 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37873 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37874 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37875 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37876 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37878 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37879 that the message be frozen.
37881 .cindex "thawing messages"
37882 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37883 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37884 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37885 that the message be thawed.
37887 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37888 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37889 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37890 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37892 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37893 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37896 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37897 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37898 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37899 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37900 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37901 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37902 which case no action is taken.
37904 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37905 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37906 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37907 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37908 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37909 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37910 case no action is taken.
37912 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37913 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37915 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37916 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37917 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37918 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37919 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37920 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37921 the address is qualified with that domain.
37924 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37925 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37926 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37927 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37928 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37929 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37930 if no output is generated.
37932 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37933 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37934 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37935 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37937 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37938 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37939 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37946 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37947 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37949 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37950 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37951 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37952 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37954 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37955 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37956 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37957 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37958 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37959 its security as compared with other MTAs.
37961 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37962 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37963 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37964 as soon as possible.
37967 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37968 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
37969 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37970 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
37971 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
37972 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
37975 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
37976 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
37977 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
37978 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
37979 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
37980 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
37982 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
37983 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37984 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37985 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
37988 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
37989 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
37990 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
37991 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
37992 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
37993 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
37994 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
37995 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
37996 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38000 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38001 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38002 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38003 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38004 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38005 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38006 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38008 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38011 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38012 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38013 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38014 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38015 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38020 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38022 .cindex "root privilege"
38023 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38024 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38025 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38026 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38027 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38028 is required for two things:
38031 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38032 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38035 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38036 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38040 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38041 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38042 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38043 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38044 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38045 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
38046 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38047 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38049 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38050 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38051 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38053 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38054 uid and gid in the following cases:
38059 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38060 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38061 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38062 the calling process.
38063 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38064 option may not be used at all.
38065 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38066 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38067 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38072 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38073 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38076 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38077 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38078 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38079 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38080 testing address verification
38083 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38086 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38087 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38090 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38093 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38094 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38095 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38096 will be used during message reception.
38098 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38099 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38101 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38102 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38103 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38104 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38105 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38106 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38107 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38108 generating bounce and warning messages.
38110 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38111 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38112 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38113 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38115 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38116 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38122 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38123 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38124 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38125 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38126 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38127 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38128 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38129 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38130 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38131 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38135 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38136 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38137 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38138 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38140 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38141 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38142 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38143 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38144 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38146 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38147 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38148 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38151 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38152 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38153 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38155 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38156 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38157 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38158 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38159 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38160 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38161 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38162 address this problem at this time.
38164 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38165 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38166 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38167 be used in the most straightforward way.
38169 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38170 number of restrictions on what you can do:
38173 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38174 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38175 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38176 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38177 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38179 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38180 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38182 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38183 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38184 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38185 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38187 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38188 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38191 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38192 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38193 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38195 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38196 owned by the Exim user.
38198 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38199 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38200 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38205 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38206 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38207 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38208 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38210 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38211 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38216 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38217 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38218 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38222 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38223 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38224 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38225 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38226 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38227 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38228 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38231 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38232 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38233 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38234 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38235 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38237 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38238 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38239 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38240 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38241 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38242 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38243 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38245 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38246 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38247 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38249 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38250 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38252 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38253 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38254 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38256 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38257 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38258 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38260 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38261 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38262 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38263 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38269 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38270 .cindex "security" "data sources"
38271 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38272 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38273 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
38274 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38275 are some issues to be aware of:
38278 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38280 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38282 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38283 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38284 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38285 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38286 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38287 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38290 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38291 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38292 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38294 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38295 expected to yield one result.
38301 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38302 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38303 .cindex "IP source routing"
38304 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38305 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38306 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38307 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38311 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38312 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38313 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38318 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38319 .cindex "trusted users"
38320 .cindex "admin user"
38321 .cindex "privileged user"
38322 .cindex "user" "trusted"
38323 .cindex "user" "admin"
38324 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38325 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38326 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38327 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38328 permit a remote host to be specified.
38331 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38332 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38333 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38334 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38335 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38336 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38338 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38339 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38340 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38341 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38342 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38344 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38345 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38346 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38347 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38348 includes the contents of files on the spool.
38352 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38353 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38354 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38355 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38356 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38357 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38359 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38360 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38361 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38362 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38363 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38364 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38367 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38368 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38369 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38370 This affects most of the checking options,
38371 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38374 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38375 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
38376 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38377 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38378 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38379 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38383 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38384 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38385 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38386 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38387 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38392 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38393 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38394 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38395 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38400 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38401 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38402 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38403 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38404 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38408 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38409 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38410 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38414 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38415 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38416 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38417 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38418 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38419 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38420 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38422 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38423 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38428 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38429 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38430 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38431 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38435 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38436 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38437 enough to hold the result.
38438 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
38443 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38444 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38446 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38447 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38448 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38449 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38450 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
38451 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38452 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38453 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38454 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38455 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38456 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38457 themselves are recoverable.
38459 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38460 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38461 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38464 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38465 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38466 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38467 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38468 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38470 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38471 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38472 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38473 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38475 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38477 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38480 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38482 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38483 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38484 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38485 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38486 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38487 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38488 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38489 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38492 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38493 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38494 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38495 relics of crashes and can be removed.
38497 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38498 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38499 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38500 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38501 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38502 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38503 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38504 normally the Exim user.
38506 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38507 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38508 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38509 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38510 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38511 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38512 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38513 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38515 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38516 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38517 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38518 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38520 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38521 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38524 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38525 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38526 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38527 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38528 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38529 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38530 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38531 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38532 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38535 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38536 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38537 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38538 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38539 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38540 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38542 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38543 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38544 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38545 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38546 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38547 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38549 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38550 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38551 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38553 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38554 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38555 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38556 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38557 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38559 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38560 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38561 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38562 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38563 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38565 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38566 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38567 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38569 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38570 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38571 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38573 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38574 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38575 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38577 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38578 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38579 present if the number is greater than zero.
38581 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38582 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38583 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38585 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38586 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38587 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38589 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38590 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38593 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38594 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38595 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38598 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38599 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38600 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38601 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38603 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38604 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38605 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38607 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38608 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38609 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38610 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38611 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38612 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38614 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38615 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38616 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38617 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38618 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38620 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38621 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38622 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38623 generated messages.
38626 The message is from a local sender.
38628 .vitem &%-localerror%&
38629 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38631 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38632 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38633 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38634 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38636 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38637 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38638 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38641 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38642 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38645 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38646 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38647 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38649 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38650 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38651 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38653 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38654 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38655 of &$spam_score_int$&.
38657 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38658 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38659 rather than Unix-format.
38660 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38661 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38663 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38664 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38665 certificate was verified by the server.
38667 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38668 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38669 name of the cipher suite that was used.
38671 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38672 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38673 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38677 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38678 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38679 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38680 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38681 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38682 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38683 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38684 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38685 addresses are complete.
38687 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38688 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38689 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38690 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38691 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38692 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38694 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38695 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38696 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38698 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38699 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38700 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38701 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38705 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38706 darcy@austen.fict.example
38708 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38710 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38711 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38712 line is of the following form:
38714 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38715 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38717 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38718 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38719 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38720 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38721 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38722 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38723 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38724 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38727 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38728 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38729 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38730 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38731 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38735 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38736 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38737 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38738 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38739 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38740 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38741 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38742 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38743 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38744 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38747 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38748 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38749 typical set of headers:
38751 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38752 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38753 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38754 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38755 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38756 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38757 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38758 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38759 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38760 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38761 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38763 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38764 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38765 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38766 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38767 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38768 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38770 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38771 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38772 an ASCII newline character.
38773 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38774 can have an alternate format.
38775 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38776 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38777 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38778 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38779 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38780 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38782 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38783 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38785 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38786 "DKIM and SPF Support"
38789 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
38791 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38792 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38793 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38794 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
38797 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
38798 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
38799 any original DKIM signature.
38802 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38803 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38805 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38807 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38808 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38809 (including transport filters)
38810 except cutthrough delivery.
38812 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38813 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38814 different signature contexts.
38817 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38818 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38819 Exim's standard controls.
38822 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38823 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
38825 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
38826 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
38827 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38828 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38830 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38831 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38832 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38833 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38837 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38838 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38839 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38840 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38844 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38845 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38848 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
38849 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38851 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38853 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38854 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38857 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
38858 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
38859 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
38860 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
38861 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
38864 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38865 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38867 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38868 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38869 After expansion, this can be a list.
38870 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38871 while expanding the remaining signing options.
38872 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
38873 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38875 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
38876 This sets the key selector string.
38877 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
38878 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
38879 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38880 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38881 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
38882 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38884 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38885 This sets the private key to use.
38886 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38887 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38888 The result can either
38890 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
38893 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or later, be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
38896 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38899 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38900 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38905 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38907 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38908 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38911 Support for EC keys is being developed under
38912 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-dcrup-dkim-crypto/).
38913 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
38914 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
38915 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
38916 for some transition period.
38917 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
38921 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
38922 Can be set alternatively to &"sha1"& to use an alternate hash
38926 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38928 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38932 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
38933 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
38934 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
38935 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
38936 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
38937 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
38939 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38940 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38941 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38942 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38943 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38945 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38946 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38947 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38948 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38949 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38952 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
38953 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
38954 list of header names.
38955 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
38956 in the message signature.
38957 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
38958 whether or not each header is present in the message.
38959 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
38960 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
38962 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
38963 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
38964 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
38966 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
38967 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
38969 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
38970 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
38971 name will be appended.
38974 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
38975 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
38977 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is implemented via the
38978 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
38979 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
38980 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
38981 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
38982 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
38983 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
38985 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
38986 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
38987 runtime of the ACL.
38989 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
38990 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
38991 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
38992 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
38994 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
38995 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
38996 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
38997 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
38998 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
38999 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39002 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39004 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39005 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39006 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39008 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39010 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39011 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39012 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39014 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39017 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39018 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39020 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39021 for each matching signature.
39024 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39025 available (from most to least important):
39029 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39030 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39031 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39032 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39034 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39035 Within the DKIM ACL,
39036 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39038 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39039 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39041 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39042 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39044 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39045 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39047 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39050 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39051 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39052 hash-method or key-size:
39054 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39055 condition = ${if eq {$len_3:$dkim_algo}{rsa}}
39056 condition = ${if or {eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39057 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}} }
39058 logwrite = NOTE: forcing dkim verify fail (was pass)
39059 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39060 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39063 After all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39064 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39066 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39067 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39068 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39070 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39071 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39073 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39074 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39076 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39077 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39078 means that the message body was modified in transit.
39080 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39081 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39082 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39083 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39086 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39088 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39089 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39090 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39091 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39093 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39094 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39095 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39096 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39098 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39099 The key record selector string.
39101 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39102 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39104 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or later, may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39105 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39110 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39112 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39114 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39115 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39118 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39119 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39122 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39123 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39125 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39126 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39128 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39129 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39130 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39131 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39132 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39133 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39135 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39136 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39137 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39138 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39140 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39141 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39142 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39144 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39145 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39146 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39147 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39148 integer size comparisons against this value.
39150 Note that Exim does not check this value.
39153 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39154 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39156 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39157 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39159 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39160 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39162 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39163 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39166 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39167 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39170 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39171 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39173 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39174 Number of bits in the key.
39177 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39179 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39180 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39183 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39184 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39185 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39190 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39193 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39194 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39195 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39196 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39197 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39200 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39201 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39202 sender_domains = gmail.com
39203 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39207 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39208 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39210 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
39211 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39212 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39213 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39216 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39217 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39218 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39219 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39222 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39223 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39224 for more information of what they mean.
39231 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39232 .cindex SPF verification
39234 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39235 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39236 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39238 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39239 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39241 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39242 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39243 &url(http://www.libspf2.org/).
39244 There is no Exim involvement on the trasmission of messages; publishing certain
39245 DNS records is all that is required.
39247 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39249 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39250 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
39251 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39252 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39253 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39257 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39260 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
39261 domain in the envelope-from address.
39263 .vitem &%softfail%&
39264 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
39268 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
39271 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
39272 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
39273 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
39275 .vitem &%permerror%&
39276 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
39277 You may deny messages when this occurs. (Changed in 4.83)
39279 .vitem &%temperror%&
39280 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
39281 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
39284 .vitem &%err_temp%&
39285 Same as permerror, deprecated in 4.83, will be removed in a future release.
39287 .vitem &%err_perm%&
39288 Same as temperror, deprecated in 4.83, will be removed in a future release.
39291 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
39292 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
39293 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
39294 short-circuit fashion.
39299 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
39300 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
39301 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
39302 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
39303 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
39304 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
39305 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
39306 ip=$sender_host_address
39309 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
39312 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
39314 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
39315 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
39316 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
39317 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
39318 it for logging purposes.
39320 .vitem &$spf_received$&
39321 .vindex &$spf_received$&
39322 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
39323 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
39324 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
39325 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
39327 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
39328 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
39330 .vitem &$spf_result$&
39331 .vindex &$spf_result$&
39332 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
39333 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
39336 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39337 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39338 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
39339 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
39343 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39344 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
39345 .cindex SPF "best guess"
39346 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
39347 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
39348 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
39350 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
39351 for a description of what it means.
39353 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
39354 of the spf one. For example:
39357 deny spf_guess = fail
39358 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
39361 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
39362 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
39363 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
39366 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
39367 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
39369 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
39370 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
39371 &%spf_guess%& option.
39372 For example, the following:
39375 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
39378 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
39381 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
39383 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
39384 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
39387 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
39390 The lookup will return the same result strings as they can appear in
39391 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
39392 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
39395 . wen-for SPF section
39399 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39400 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39402 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
39404 .cindex "proxy support"
39405 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
39407 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
39408 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
39411 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
39412 .cindex proxy inbound
39413 .cindex proxy "server side"
39414 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
39415 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
39417 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
39418 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
39419 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
39422 It was built on specifications from:
39423 (&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
39424 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
39425 (&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
39427 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
39428 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
39429 to distribute load.
39430 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
39431 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
39432 There is no logging if a host passes or
39433 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
39434 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
39436 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
39437 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
39438 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
39439 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
39440 automatically determines which version is in use.
39442 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
39443 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
39444 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
39445 Exim and the proxy server.
39447 The following expansion variables are usable
39448 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
39451 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
39452 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
39453 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
39454 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
39455 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
39457 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
39458 there was a protocol error.
39460 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
39461 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
39462 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
39463 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
39464 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
39465 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
39466 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
39467 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
39468 A possible solution is:
39470 # Set max number of connections per host
39472 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
39473 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
39475 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
39476 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
39481 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
39482 .cindex proxy outbound
39483 .cindex proxy "client side"
39484 .cindex proxy SOCKS
39485 .cindex SOCKS proxy
39486 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
39487 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
39488 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
39491 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
39492 on an smtp transport.
39493 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
39494 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
39495 Each proxy specifier is a list
39496 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
39497 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
39499 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
39500 The list of options is in the following table:
39502 &'auth '& authentication method
39503 &'name '& authentication username
39504 &'pass '& authentication password
39506 &'tmo '& connection timeout
39508 &'weight '& selection bias
39511 More details on each of these options follows:
39514 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
39515 .cindex proxy authentication
39516 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
39517 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
39518 for access to the proxy.
39519 Default is &"none"&.
39521 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
39524 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
39527 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
39530 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
39533 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
39534 higher values being tried first.
39535 The default priority is 1.
39537 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
39538 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
39539 weighted by this value.
39540 The default value for selection bias is 1.
39543 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
39544 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
39545 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
39547 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
39548 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
39549 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
39550 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
39552 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39553 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39555 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
39556 "Internationalisation""
39557 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
39560 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
39562 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
39563 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
39564 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
39566 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
39567 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
39568 requirement, upon libidn2.
39570 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
39571 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
39572 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
39573 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
39574 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
39575 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
39577 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39578 international handling for the message is enabled and
39579 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
39581 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
39582 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
39583 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
39584 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
39586 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
39587 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
39588 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
39589 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
39591 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
39592 components expanded to a-label form,
39593 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
39596 .cindex log protocol
39597 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
39598 .cindex i18n logging
39599 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
39600 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
39602 The following expansion operators can be used:
39604 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
39605 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
39606 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
39607 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
39610 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
39611 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
39615 may use the following modifier:
39617 control = utf8_downconvert
39618 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
39620 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
39621 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
39622 Message Submission Agent context.
39623 If a value is appended it may be:
39625 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39626 &`0 `& no downconversion
39627 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39630 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39631 is initially set to -1.
39634 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39635 Configurations supporting these should inspect
39636 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39638 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39639 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39640 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39642 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39643 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39647 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39648 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39649 the following expansion operator can be used:
39651 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39654 The string is converted from the charset specified by
39655 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39656 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39658 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39659 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
39660 (which has to be a single character)
39661 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
39662 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
39664 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
39665 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
39667 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
39668 by many other IMAP servers.
39672 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
39673 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
39674 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
39677 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39678 must be representable in UTF-16.
39681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39684 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39688 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39689 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39690 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39691 processing actions.
39693 Most installations will never need to use Events.
39694 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39695 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39697 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39698 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39699 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39701 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39702 An example might look like:
39703 .cindex logging custom
39705 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39706 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39707 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39708 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39709 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39710 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39711 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39712 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39713 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39717 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39718 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39719 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39721 The current list of events is:
39723 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
39724 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
39725 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39726 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39727 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39728 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39729 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39730 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39731 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39732 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39733 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39734 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39736 New event types may be added in future.
39738 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39739 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39740 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39742 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39743 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39744 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39746 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
39747 should define the event action.
39749 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39750 with the event type:
39752 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
39753 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39754 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39755 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39756 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
39757 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39758 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39761 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39763 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39764 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39765 the course of its processing:
39767 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39770 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39771 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39773 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39774 a useful way of writing to the main log.
39776 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39777 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39778 following will be forced:
39780 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39781 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39782 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
39784 All other message types ignore the result string, and
39785 no other use is made of it.
39787 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39788 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39791 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39792 chain element received on the connection.
39793 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39796 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39799 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39800 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39801 .cindex "adding drivers"
39802 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
39803 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39804 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39805 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39808 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39809 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39811 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39813 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39815 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39816 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39817 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39819 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39821 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39824 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39825 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39827 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39828 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39829 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39830 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39831 simple form that most lookups have.
39833 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39834 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39835 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39837 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39840 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39841 as for other drivers and lookups.
39844 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39845 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39846 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39847 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39848 searched using a binary chop procedure.
39850 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39851 the interface that is expected.
39856 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39857 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39859 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39860 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39861 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
39862 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
39864 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39869 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
39870 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
39874 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
39875 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
39876 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
39879 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39880 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////